blob: cf0d69606418bee216e9f08034d608a1c65f2ea6 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf08137c2017-10-22 10:13:45 +02007 2017/10/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000593 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000594 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200595 - tune.buffers.limit
596 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200597 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200598 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100599 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100600 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200601 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200602 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100603 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100604 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100605 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100606 - tune.lua.session-timeout
607 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200608 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100609 - tune.maxaccept
610 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200611 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200612 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200613 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100614 - tune.rcvbuf.client
615 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100616 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100617 - tune.sndbuf.client
618 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100619 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100620 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200621 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100622 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200623 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200624 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100625 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200626 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100627 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200628 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
629 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
630 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100631 - tune.zlib.memlevel
632 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 * Debugging
635 - debug
636 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637
638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006393.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640------------------------------------
641
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200642ca-base <dir>
643 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200644 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
645 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647chroot <jail dir>
648 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
649 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
650 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
651 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
652 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
653 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100654
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
656 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
657 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
658 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100659 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
660 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
661 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
662 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
663 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
664 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
665 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
666 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
667 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
668 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100669
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200670crt-base <dir>
671 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
672 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
673 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675daemon
676 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
677 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
678 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
679
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200680deviceatlas-json-file <path>
681 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
682 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
683
684deviceatlas-log-level <value>
685 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
686 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
687
688deviceatlas-separator <char>
689 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
690 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
691
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100692deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200693 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
694 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
695 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100696
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900697external-check
698 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
699 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
700 See "option external-check".
701
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702gid <number>
703 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
704 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
705 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100706 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
707 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100710hard-stop-after <time>
711 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
712
713 Arguments :
714 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
715 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
716 SIGUSR1 signal.
717
718 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
719 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
720 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
721
722 Example:
723 global
724 hard-stop-after 30s
725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726group <group name>
727 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
728 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100729
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200730log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
732 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100733 configured with "log global".
734
735 <address> can be one of:
736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100737 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100738 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
739 port).
740
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100741 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
742 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
743 port).
744
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
746 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
747 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
748 writeable).
749
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
751 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100752
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200753 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
754 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
755 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
756 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
757 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
758 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
759 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
760 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
761 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
762 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200763 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
764 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200765
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200766 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
767 one of the following :
768
769 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
770 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
771
772 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
773 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
774
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100775 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
777 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
778 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
779 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
780
781 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200782 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
783 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
784 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
785 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
786 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
787 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200788
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200789 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100791log-send-hostname [<string>]
792 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
793 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
794 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
795 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
796 the logs.
797
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000798log-tag <string>
799 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
800 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
801 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100802 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000803
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100804lua-load <file>
805 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
806 used multiple times.
807
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200808master-worker [exit-on-failure]
809 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
810 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
811 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
812 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
813 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
814 systemd.
815 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
816 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
817 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
818 the whole process.
819
820 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822nbproc <number>
823 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
824 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
825 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
826 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
827 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
828
829pidfile <pidfile>
830 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
831 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
832 starting the process. See also "daemon".
833
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100834presetenv <name> <value>
835 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
836 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
837 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
838 and "unsetenv".
839
840resetenv [<name> ...]
841 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
842 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
843 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
844 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
845 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
846 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
847 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
848 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
849
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100850stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200851 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
852 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
853 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
854 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
855 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
856 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100857 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200858 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
859 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200860
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200861server-state-base <directory>
862 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200863 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
864 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200865
866server-state-file <file>
867 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
868 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
869 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
870 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
871 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
872 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
873 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
874 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200875 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
876 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200877
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100878setenv <name> <value>
879 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
880 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
881 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
882 and "unsetenv".
883
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100884ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
886 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300887 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100888 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
889 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
890 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
891 "bind" keyword for more information.
892
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100893ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
895 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
896 keyword to see available options.
897
898 Example:
899 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200900 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100901
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100902ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
904 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300905 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100906 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
907 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
908 information.
909
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100910ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
912 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
913 keyword to see available options.
914
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200915ssl-dh-param-file <file>
916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
917 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
918 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
919 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
920 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200921 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
922 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
923 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
924 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200925 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
926 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
927 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
928
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100929ssl-server-verify [none|required]
930 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
931 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
932 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
933
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200934stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
935 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
936 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
937 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200938 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200939 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200940
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200941 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
942 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
943 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200944
945stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
946 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
947 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100948 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200949
950stats maxconn <connections>
951 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
952 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
953
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954uid <number>
955 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
956 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
957 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
958 one. See also "gid" and "user".
959
960ulimit-n <number>
961 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
962 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
963 option.
964
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100965unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
966 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
967
968 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
969 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
970 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
971 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
972 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
973 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
974 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
975 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
976 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
977 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
978
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100979unsetenv [<name> ...]
980 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
981 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
982 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
983 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
984 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
985 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
986 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
987
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200988user <user name>
989 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
990 See also "uid" and "group".
991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200992node <name>
993 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
994
995 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
996 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
997 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
998 traffic.
999
1000description <text>
1001 Add a text that describes the instance.
1002
1003 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1004 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1005 "<" and ">" characters.
1006
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100100751degrees-data-file <file path>
1008 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1009 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1010
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001011 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001012 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1013
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000101451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001015 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1016 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1017 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1018
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001019 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001020 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1021
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200102251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001023 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1024 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1025
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001026 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1027 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1028
102951degrees-cache-size <number>
1030 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1031 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1032 By default, this cache is disabled.
1033
1034 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001035 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1036
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001037wurfl-data-file <file path>
1038 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1039 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1040
1041 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1042 with USE_WURFL=1.
1043
1044wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1045 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1046 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1047 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1048
1049 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1050
1051 Valid WURFL properties are:
1052 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1053
1054 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1055 device.
1056
1057 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1058 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1059
1060 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1061 particular web request.
1062
1063 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1064 used Libwurfl API version.
1065
1066 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1067 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1068 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1069
1070 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1071 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1072
1073 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1074 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1075
1076 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1077
1078 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1079
1080 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1081 with USE_WURFL=1.
1082
1083wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1084 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1085 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1086
1087 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1088 with USE_WURFL=1.
1089
1090wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1091 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1092 thus before the chroot.
1093
1094 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1095 with USE_WURFL=1.
1096
1097wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1098 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1099 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1100 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1101 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1102 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1103 mode is enabled by default.
1104
1105 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1106 with USE_WURFL=1.
1107
1108wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1109 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1110 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1111 - "0" : no cache is used.
1112 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1113 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1114 the highest performing option.
1115
1116 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1117 with USE_WURFL=1.
1118
1119wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1120 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1121 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1122
1123 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1124 with USE_WURFL=1.
1125
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128-----------------------
1129
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001130max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1131 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1132 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1133 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1134 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1135 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1136 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1137 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1138 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1139
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001140maxconn <number>
1141 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1142 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1143 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001144 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1145 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1146 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1147 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001148 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1149 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1150 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1151 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1152 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001153
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001154maxconnrate <number>
1155 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1156 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1157 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1158 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1159 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1160 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1161 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1162 fairness.
1163
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001164maxcomprate <number>
1165 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001166 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001167 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1168 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1169 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1170 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1171 default value.
1172
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001173maxcompcpuusage <number>
1174 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1175 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1176 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1177 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1178 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1179 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1180 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1181 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1182
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001183maxpipes <number>
1184 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1185 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1186 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1187 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1188 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1189 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1190
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001191maxsessrate <number>
1192 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1193 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1194 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1195 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1196 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1197 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1198 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1199 fairness.
1200
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001201maxsslconn <number>
1202 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1203 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1204 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1205 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1206 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1207 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1208 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001209 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1210 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1211 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1212 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1213 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1214 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1215 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001216
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001217maxsslrate <number>
1218 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1219 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1220 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1221 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1222 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1223 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1224 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1225 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1226 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1227 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1228
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001229maxzlibmem <number>
1230 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1231 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1232 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001233 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1234 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1235 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1236
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001237noepoll
1238 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1239 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001240 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241
1242nokqueue
1243 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1244 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1245 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1246
1247nopoll
1248 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1249 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001250 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001251 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001252
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001253nosplice
1254 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1255 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1256 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001257 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001258 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1259 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1260 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1261 "option splice-response".
1262
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001263nogetaddrinfo
1264 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1265 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1266
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001267noreuseport
1268 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1269 command line argument "-dR".
1270
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001271spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001272 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1273 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1274 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1275 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1276 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1277 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001278
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001279ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1280 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1281 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1282 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1283 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1284 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1285 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1286 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1287 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1288 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1289 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1290 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1291 openssl configuration file uses:
1292 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1293
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001294ssl-mode-async
1295 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001296 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001297 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1298 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1299 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1300 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1301 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001302
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001303tune.buffers.limit <number>
1304 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1305 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1306 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1307 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1308 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1309 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1310 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1311 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1312 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1313 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1314 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1315 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1316 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1317 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1318 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1319
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001320tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1321 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1322 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1323 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1324 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1325
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001326tune.bufsize <number>
1327 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1328 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1329 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1330 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1331 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1332 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1333 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1334 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001335 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1336 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1337 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001338
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001339tune.chksize <number>
1340 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1341 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1342 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1343 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1344 checks whenever possible.
1345
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001346tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1347 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1348 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1349 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1350 this value. The default value is 1.
1351
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001352tune.http.cookielen <number>
1353 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1354 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1355 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1356 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1357 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1358 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1359 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1360 to change this value.
1361
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001362tune.http.logurilen <number>
1363 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1364 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1365 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1366 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1367 configuration directives too.
1368 The default value is 1024.
1369
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001370tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1371 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1372 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1373 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1374 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1375 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1376 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001377 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1378 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1379 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001380
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001381tune.idletimer <timeout>
1382 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1383 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1384 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1385 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1386 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1387 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1388 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1389 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1390 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1391
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001392tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1393 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001394 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001395 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1396 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1397 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1398 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1399 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1400
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001401tune.lua.maxmem
1402 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1403 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1404 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1405 memory.
1406
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001407tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1408 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001409 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1410 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1411 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001412
1413tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1414 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1415 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1416 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1417 check servers.
1418
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001419tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1420 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1421 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1422 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1423 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1424
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001425tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001426 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1427 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1428 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1429 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1430 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1431 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1432 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1433 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1434 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1435 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001436
1437tune.maxpollevents <number>
1438 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1439 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1440 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1441 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1442 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1443
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001444tune.maxrewrite <number>
1445 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1446 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1447 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1448 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1449 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1450 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1451 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1452 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1453 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1454 bufsize.
1455
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001456tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1457 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1458 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1459 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1460 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1461 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1462 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1463 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1464 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1465 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1466 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1467 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1468 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1469 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1470 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1471 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1472 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1473 setting this parameter to 0.
1474
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001475tune.pipesize <number>
1476 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1477 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1478 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1479 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1480 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1481 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1482
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001483tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1484tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1485 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1486 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1487 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1488 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1489 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1490 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1491 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1492
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001493tune.recv_enough <number>
1494 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1495 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1496 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1497 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1498 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1499
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001500tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1501tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1502 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1503 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1504 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1505 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1506 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1507 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1508 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1509 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1510 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1511 notifying haproxy again.
1512
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001513tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001514 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1515 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1516 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001517 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001518 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1519 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1520 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1521 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1522 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001523 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1524 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001525
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001526tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1527 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1528 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1529 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1530 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1531 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1532 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1533
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001534tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1535 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001536 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001537 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1538 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1539 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1540 being used for too long.
1541
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001542tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1543 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1544 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1545 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1546 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1547 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1548 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1549 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1550 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1551 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1552 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001553 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1554 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001555
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001556tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1557 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1558 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1559 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1560 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1561 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1562 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1563 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001564 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1565 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001566
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001567tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1568 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1569 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1570 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1571 1000 entries.
1572
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001573tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1574 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1575 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1576 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1577
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001578tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001579tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001580tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1581tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1582tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001583 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1584 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1585 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1586 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1587 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1588 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1589 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1590 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001591
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001592 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1593 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1594 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1595 all available space is consumed.
1596 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1597 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1598 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001599
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001600tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1601 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001602 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001603 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1604 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1605 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1606
1607tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1608 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1609 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1610 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1611 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016133.3. Debugging
1614--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001615
1616debug
1617 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1618 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1619 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1620 system startup.
1621
1622quiet
1623 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1624 line argument "-q".
1625
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016273.4. Userlists
1628--------------
1629It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1630http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1631it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1632
1633userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001634 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001635 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1636
1637group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001638 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001639 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1640 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1641
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001642user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1643 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001644 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1645 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001646 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1647 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001648 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001649 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001650
1651
1652 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001653 userlist L1
1654 group G1 users tiger,scott
1655 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001656
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001657 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1658 user scott insecure-password elgato
1659 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001660
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001661 userlist L2
1662 group G1
1663 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001664
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001665 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1666 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1667 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001668
1669 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001670
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001671
16723.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001673----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001674It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1675several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1676instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1677values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1678automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1679In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1680using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1681tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1682reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1683Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1684that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1685each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001686
1687peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001688 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001689 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1690
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001691disabled
1692 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1693 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1694 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1695
1696enable
1697 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1698
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001699peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1700 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1701 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1702 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1703 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1704 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1705 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1706
1707 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1708 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1709
1710 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1711 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1712 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1713 across all peers.
1714
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001715 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1716 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001717
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001718 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001719 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001720 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1721 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1722 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001723
1724 backend mybackend
1725 mode tcp
1726 balance roundrobin
1727 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1728 stick on src
1729
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001730 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1731 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001732
1733
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017343.6. Mailers
1735------------
1736It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1737If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1738in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1739
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001740mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001741 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1742 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1743
1744mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1745 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1746
1747 Example:
1748 mailers mymailers
1749 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1750 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1751
1752 backend mybackend
1753 mode tcp
1754 balance roundrobin
1755
1756 email-alert mailers mymailers
1757 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1758 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1759
1760 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1761 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1762
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001763timeout mail <time>
1764 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1765 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1766 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1767 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1768
1769 Example:
1770 mailers mymailers
1771 timeout mail 20s
1772 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017744. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001775----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001777Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001778 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001779 - frontend <name>
1780 - backend <name>
1781 - listen <name>
1782
1783A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1784its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1785section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001787
1788A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1789connections.
1790
1791A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1792to forward incoming connections.
1793
1794A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1795parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1798'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1799case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1800
1801Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1802logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1803proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1804However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1805name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1806
1807Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1808and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001809bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1811modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1812arbitrary criteria.
1813
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001814In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1815a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1816the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1817
1818 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1819 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1820 between responses and new requests.
1821
1822 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1823 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1824 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1825 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1826
1827 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1828 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1829 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1830
1831 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1832 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1833 client-facing connection remains open.
1834
1835 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1836 after the end of the response.
1837
1838The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1839frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1840following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1841weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1842
1843 Backend mode
1844
1845 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1846 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1847 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1848 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1849 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1850 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1851 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1852 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1853 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1854 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1855 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1860--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001862The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1863limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1864they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1865limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001866marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001867option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001868and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1869with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1870specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001872
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001873 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1874------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1875acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001876appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001877backlog X X X -
1878balance X - X X
1879bind - X X -
1880bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001881block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001882capture cookie - X X -
1883capture request header - X X -
1884capture response header - X X -
1885clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001886compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001887contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1888cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001889declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001890default-server X - X X
1891default_backend X X X -
1892description - X X X
1893disabled X X X X
1894dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001895email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001896email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001897email-alert mailers X X X X
1898email-alert myhostname X X X X
1899email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900enabled X X X X
1901errorfile X X X X
1902errorloc X X X X
1903errorloc302 X X X X
1904-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1905errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001906force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001907filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908fullconn X - X X
1909grace X X X X
1910hash-type X - X X
1911http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001912http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001913http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001914http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001915http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001916http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001917http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001918id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001919ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001920load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001921log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001922log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001923log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001924log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001925max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001926maxconn X X X -
1927mode X X X X
1928monitor fail - X X -
1929monitor-net X X X -
1930monitor-uri X X X -
1931option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1932option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1933option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1934option allbackups (*) X - X X
1935option checkcache (*) X - X X
1936option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1937option contstats (*) X X X -
1938option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1939option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1940option forceclose (*) X X X X
1941-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1942option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001943option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001944option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001945option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001946option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001947option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001948option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001949option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001950option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1951option httpchk X - X X
1952option httpclose (*) X X X X
1953option httplog X X X X
1954option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001955option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001956option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001957option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001958option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1959option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1960option logasap (*) X X X -
1961option mysql-check X - X X
1962option nolinger (*) X X X X
1963option originalto X X X X
1964option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001965option pgsql-check X - X X
1966option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001967option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001968option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001969option smtpchk X - X X
1970option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1971option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1972option splice-request (*) X X X X
1973option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001974option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001975option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1976option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1977-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001978option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1980option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1981option tcpka X X X X
1982option tcplog X X X X
1983option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001984external-check command X - X X
1985external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001986persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1987rate-limit sessions X X X -
1988redirect - X X X
1989redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1990redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1991reqadd - X X X
1992reqallow - X X X
1993reqdel - X X X
1994reqdeny - X X X
1995reqiallow - X X X
1996reqidel - X X X
1997reqideny - X X X
1998reqipass - X X X
1999reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002000reqitarpit - X X X
2001reqpass - X X X
2002reqrep - X X X
2003-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002004reqtarpit - X X X
2005retries X - X X
2006rspadd - X X X
2007rspdel - X X X
2008rspdeny - X X X
2009rspidel - X X X
2010rspideny - X X X
2011rspirep - X X X
2012rsprep - X X X
2013server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002014server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002015server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016source X - X X
2017srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002018stats admin - X X X
2019stats auth X X X X
2020stats enable X X X X
2021stats hide-version X X X X
2022stats http-request - X X X
2023stats realm X X X X
2024stats refresh X X X X
2025stats scope X X X X
2026stats show-desc X X X X
2027stats show-legends X X X X
2028stats show-node X X X X
2029stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002030-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2031stick match - - X X
2032stick on - - X X
2033stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002034stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002035stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002036tcp-check connect - - X X
2037tcp-check expect - - X X
2038tcp-check send - - X X
2039tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002040tcp-request connection - X X -
2041tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002042tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002043tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002044tcp-response content - - X X
2045tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002046timeout check X - X X
2047timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002048timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002049timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2050timeout connect X - X X
2051timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2052timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2053timeout http-request X X X X
2054timeout queue X - X X
2055timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002056timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002057timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2058timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002059timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002060transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002061unique-id-format X X X -
2062unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002063use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002064use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002065------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2066 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020694.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2070---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
2072This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2073
2074
2075acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2076 Declare or complete an access list.
2077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2078 no | yes | yes | yes
2079 Example:
2080 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2081 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2082 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002084 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085
2086
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002087appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2088 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2091 no | no | yes | yes
2092 Arguments :
2093 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2094 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2095
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002096 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097 checked in each cookie value.
2098
2099 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2100 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2101 milliseconds.
2102
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002103 request-learn
2104 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2105 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2106 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2107 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2108 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2109 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2110
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002111 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2112 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2113 data following this prefix.
2114
2115 Example :
2116 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2117
2118 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2119 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2120
2121 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2122 2 modes are currently supported :
2123 - path-parameters :
2124 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2125 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2126 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2127 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2128 - query-string :
2129 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2130 query string.
2131
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002132 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2133 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2134 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002135
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002136 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2137 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002138
2139
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002140backlog <conns>
2141 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2143 yes | yes | yes | no
2144 Arguments :
2145 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2146 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002147 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002148
2149 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2150 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2151 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2152 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2153 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2154 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2155 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2156 backlog parameter.
2157
2158 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2159 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2160 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2161
2162 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2163
2164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002166balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2169 yes | no | yes | yes
2170 Arguments :
2171 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2172 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2173 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2174 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2175
2176 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2177 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2178 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2179 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002180 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002181 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002182 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2183 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2184 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2185 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2186 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2187 it, so that you don't worry.
2188
2189 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2190 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2191 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2192 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2193 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2194 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2195 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2196 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002198 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2199 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2200 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2201 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2202 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2203 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2204 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2205 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2206
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002207 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002208 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002209 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2210 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002211 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002212 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2213 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2214 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2215 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2216 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002217 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2218 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2219 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2220 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2221 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2222 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002223
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2225 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2226 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2227 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2228 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2229 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2230 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2231 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002232 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002233 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002234 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2235 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2236 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002237
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002238 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2239 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2240 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2241 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2242 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2243 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2244 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2245 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2246 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2247 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2248 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2249 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002250
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002251 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002252 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2253 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2254 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2255 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2256 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2257 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2258 URIs start with a leading "/".
2259
2260 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2261 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2262 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2263 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002266 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2267
2268 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002269 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2270 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002271 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2272 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2273 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2274 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002275 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002276 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2277 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002278
2279 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2280 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2281 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2282 server will receive the request.
2283
2284 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2285 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2286 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2287 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2288 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002289 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2290 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2291 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002292
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002293 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2294 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2295 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2296 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2297 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002299 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002300 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2301 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2302 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2303
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002304 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2305 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2306 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2307
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002308 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002309 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002310 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2311 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2312 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2313 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2314 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2315 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002316 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002317 used instead.
2318
2319 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2320 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2321 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2322 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2323
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002324 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2325 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2326 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2327
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002328 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002330 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002331 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2332 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002333
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002334 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2335 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2336 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337
2338 Examples :
2339 balance roundrobin
2340 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002341 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002342 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2343 balance hdr(host)
2344 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002345
2346 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2347 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002349 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002350 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2351 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2352 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2353 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2354
2355 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2356 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2357 defaults to 16 kB.
2358
2359 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2360 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2361
2362 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2363 Round Robin.
2364
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002365 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002366 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2367 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2368 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2369
2370 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2371
2372 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002373 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002374 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2375 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2376 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002378 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379
2380
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002381bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2382bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2385 no | yes | yes | no
2386 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002387 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2388 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2389 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2390 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002391 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002392 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2393 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2394 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2395 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2396 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2397 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2398 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002399 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2400 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2401 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2402 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2403 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2404 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2405 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002406 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2407 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2408 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002409 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2410 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2411 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002412
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002413 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2414 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002415 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2416 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2417 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002418 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2419 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2420 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2421 the range.
2422
2423 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2424 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2425 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2426 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2427 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2428 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2429 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002430 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002431 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002432
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002433 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2434 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2435 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2436 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2437 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2438 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2439 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2440 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002442 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2443 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2444 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2445 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2448 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2449 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2450 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2451 in a frontend.
2452
2453 Example :
2454 listen http_proxy
2455 bind :80,:443
2456 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002457 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002459 listen http_https_proxy
2460 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002461 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002462
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002463 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2464 bind ipv6@:80
2465 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2466 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2467
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002468 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002469 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002470
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002471 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2472 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2473 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2474 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2475 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2476
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002477 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002478 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479
2480
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002481bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002482 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 yes | yes | yes | yes
2485 Arguments :
2486 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2487 may be used to override a default value.
2488
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002489 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002490 option may be combined with other numbers.
2491
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002492 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002493 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2494 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2495 missing from all processes.
2496
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002497 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002498 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002499 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2500 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2501 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2502 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002503
2504 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2505 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2506 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2507 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2508 and 'even' instances.
2509
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002510 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2511 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2512 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2513 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002514
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002515 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2516 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2517
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002518 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2519 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2520 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2521
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002522 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2523 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2524
2525 Example :
2526 listen app_ip1
2527 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002528 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002529
2530 listen app_ip2
2531 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002532 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002533
2534 listen management
2535 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002536 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002537
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002538 listen management
2539 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2540 bind-process 1-4
2541
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002542 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002543
2544
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002545block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002546 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 no | yes | yes | yes
2549
2550 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2551 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002552 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002553 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002554 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002555 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2556 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2557 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002559 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2560 "http-request deny" instead.
2561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562 Example:
2563 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2564 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2565 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002566 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2567 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2568 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002570 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2571 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2572 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573
2574capture cookie <name> len <length>
2575 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2577 no | yes | yes | no
2578 Arguments :
2579 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2580 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2581 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2582 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2583 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2584
2585 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2586 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2587 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2588 right if it exceeds <length>.
2589
2590 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2591 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2592 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2593 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2594
2595 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2596 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2597 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2598
2599 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2600 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2601 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002602 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2603 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2604 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605
2606 Example:
2607 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2608
2609 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002610 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611
2612
2613capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002614 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2616 no | yes | yes | no
2617 Arguments :
2618 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002619 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2621 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2622 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2623
2624 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2625 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2626 it exceeds <length>.
2627
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002628 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2630 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002631 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2632 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2633 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2634 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002635 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002636 environments to find where the request came from.
2637
2638 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2639 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2640 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2641 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002643 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2644 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2645 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2646 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2647 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648
2649 Example:
2650 capture request header Host len 15
2651 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002652 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002654 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002655 about logging.
2656
2657
2658capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002659 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2661 no | yes | yes | no
2662 Arguments :
2663 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002664 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2666 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2667 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2668
2669 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2670 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2671 it exceeds <length>.
2672
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002673 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2675 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2676 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002677 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2678 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2679 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2680 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002681
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002682 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2683 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2684 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2685 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2686 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687
2688 Example:
2689 capture response header Content-length len 9
2690 capture response header Location len 15
2691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002692 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693 about logging.
2694
2695
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002696clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002697 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2699 yes | yes | yes | no
2700 Arguments :
2701 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2702 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2703 as explained at the top of this document.
2704
2705 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2706 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2707 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2708 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2709 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2710 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2711 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2712 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002713 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2715 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2716
2717 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2718 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2719 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2720 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2721 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2722 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2723
2724 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2725 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2726
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002727 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2728 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002729
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002730compression algo <algorithm> ...
2731compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002732compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002733 Enable HTTP compression.
2734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2735 yes | yes | yes | yes
2736 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002737 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2738 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2739 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2740
2741 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002742 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2743 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2744 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002745
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002746 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002747 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002748
2749 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2750 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2751 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2752 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2753 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002754 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002755
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002756 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2757 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2758 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2759 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2760 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2761 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2762 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002763 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002764
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002765 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002766 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002767 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2768 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2769 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2770 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2771 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002772
2773 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2774 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2775 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2776 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2777 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002778 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2779 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2780 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2781 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2782 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002783 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2784 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002785
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002786 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002787 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2788 "Accept-Encoding" header
2789 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002790 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002791 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2792 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002793 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2794 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2795 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2796 "multipart"
2797 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2798 header
2799 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2800 and later
2801 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2802 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002803
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002804 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2805 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002806
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002807 Examples :
2808 compression algo gzip
2809 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002811
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002812contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002813 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2815 yes | no | yes | yes
2816 Arguments :
2817 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2818 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2819 as explained at the top of this document.
2820
2821 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002822 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002823 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2825 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2826 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2827 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2828
2829 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2830 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2831 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2832 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2833 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2834 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2835
2836 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2837 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2838 instead.
2839
2840 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2841 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2842
2843
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002844cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002845 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2846 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002847 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2850 yes | no | yes | yes
2851 Arguments :
2852 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2853 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2854 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2855 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2856 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2857 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2858 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2859 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2860 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2861
2862 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2863 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2864 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2865 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2866 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2867 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002868 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2869 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2870 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2871 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2872 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002873
2874 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002875 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002876
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002877 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002878 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2879 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2880 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2881 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2882 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2883 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2884 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2885 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2886 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2887 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888
2889 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2890 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2891 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2892 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2893 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2894 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2895 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2896 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2897 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002898 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002899 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2900 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2901 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002902
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002903 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2904 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2905 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002906 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2907 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2908 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2909 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002910 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2911 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2912 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
2914 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2915 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2916 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2917 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2918 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2919 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2920 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2921 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2922 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2923
2924 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2925 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2926 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2927 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2928 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2929 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2930 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2931 persistence cookie in the cache.
2932 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2933
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002934 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2935 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2936 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2937 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2938 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2939 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2940 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2941 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2942 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2943 they logout.
2944
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002945 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2946 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2947 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2948 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2949
2950 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2951 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2952 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2953 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2954 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2955 this attribute.
2956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002957 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002958 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002959 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2960 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2961 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2962 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2963 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2964 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002965
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002966 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2967 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2968 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2969 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2970 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2971 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2972 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2973 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2974 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2975 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2976 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2977 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2978 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2979 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2980 the site.
2981
2982 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2983 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2984 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2985 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2986 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2987 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2988 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2989 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2990 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2991 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2992 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2993 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2994 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2995 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2996 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2997 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2998
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002999 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3000 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3001 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3002 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3003 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3004 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3007 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3008 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3009 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003011 Examples :
3012 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3013 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3014 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003015 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003016
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003017 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003018
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003019
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003020declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3021 Declares a capture slot.
3022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3023 no | yes | yes | no
3024 Arguments:
3025 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3026
3027 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3028 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3029 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3030 for use in the response.
3031
3032 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003033 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003034 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3035
3036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003037default-server [param*]
3038 Change default options for a server in a backend
3039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3040 yes | no | yes | yes
3041 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003042 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3043 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3044 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3045 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003046
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003047 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003048 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3049
3050 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003052
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003053default_backend <backend>
3054 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | no
3057 Arguments :
3058 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3059
3060 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3061 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3062 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3063 will catch all undetermined requests.
3064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065 Example :
3066
3067 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3068 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3069 default_backend dynamic
3070
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003071 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003072
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003074description <string>
3075 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3077 no | yes | yes | yes
3078 Arguments : string
3079
3080 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3081 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3082 it describes.
3083 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3084
3085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086disabled
3087 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 yes | yes | yes | yes
3090 Arguments : none
3091
3092 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3093 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3094 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3095 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3096 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3097 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3098 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3099
3100 See also : "enabled"
3101
3102
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003103dispatch <address>:<port>
3104 Set a default server address
3105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3106 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003107 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003108
3109 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3110 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3111 during start-up.
3112
3113 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3114 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3115 possible with normal servers.
3116
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003117 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003118 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3119 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3120 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3121 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3122
3123 See also : "server"
3124
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003125
3126dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3127 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3129 yes | no | yes | yes
3130 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3131
3132 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3133 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3134 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3135 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3136 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3137 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139enabled
3140 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143 Arguments : none
3144
3145 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3146 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3147
3148 See also : "disabled"
3149
3150
3151errorfile <code> <file>
3152 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3154 yes | yes | yes | yes
3155 Arguments :
3156 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003157 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3158 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159
3160 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003161 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003163 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3164 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165
3166 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3167 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3168 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3169
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003170 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003172 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3173 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3174 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3175 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3176
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003177 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3178 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3179 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3180 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3181 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3182 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3185 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3186 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003187 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3189
3190 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3191
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003192 Example :
3193 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003194 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003195 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3196 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3197
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003198
3199errorloc <code> <url>
3200errorloc302 <code> <url>
3201 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3203 yes | yes | yes | yes
3204 Arguments :
3205 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003206 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3207 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003208
3209 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3210 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3211 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3212 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3213 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3214
3215 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3216 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3217 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3218
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003219 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3220
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003221 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3222 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3223 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3224 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003225 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003226 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3227 request.
3228
3229 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3230
3231
3232errorloc303 <code> <url>
3233 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3235 yes | yes | yes | yes
3236 Arguments :
3237 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003238 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3239 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003240
3241 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3242 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3243 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3244 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3245 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3246
3247 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3248 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3249 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3250
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003251 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3252
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003253 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3254 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3255 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3256 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003257 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003258
3259 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3260
3261
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003262email-alert from <emailaddr>
3263 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3264 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3266 yes | yes | yes | yes
3267
3268 Arguments :
3269
3270 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3271
3272 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3273 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3274
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003275 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003276 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3277 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003278
3279
3280email-alert level <level>
3281 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3282 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3284 yes | yes | yes | yes
3285
3286 Arguments :
3287
3288 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3289 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3290 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3291
3292 By default level is alert
3293
3294 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3295 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3296 for the proxy.
3297
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003298 Alerts are sent when :
3299
3300 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3301 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3302 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3303 is notice or lower
3304 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3305 and a health check status update occurs
3306
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003307 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3308 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003309 section 3.6 about mailers.
3310
3311
3312email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3313 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3314 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3315 yes | yes | yes | yes
3316
3317 Arguments :
3318
3319 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3320
3321 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3322 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3323
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003324 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3325 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003326
3327
3328email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3329 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3330 mailers.
3331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3332 yes | yes | yes | yes
3333
3334 Arguments :
3335
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003336 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003337
3338 By default the systems hostname is used.
3339
3340 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3341 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3342 for the proxy.
3343
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003344 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3345 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003346
3347
3348email-alert to <emailaddr>
3349 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3350 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3351 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3352 yes | yes | yes | yes
3353
3354 Arguments :
3355
3356 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3357
3358 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3359 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3360
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003361 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003362 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3363
3364
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003365force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3366 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3368 no | yes | yes | yes
3369
3370 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3371 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3372 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3373 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3374 marked down for maintenance operations.
3375
3376 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3377 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3378 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3379 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3380 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3381 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3382 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3383 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3384 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3385
3386 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3387 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3388 is used.
3389
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003390 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003391 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003392
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003393
3394filter <name> [param*]
3395 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3397 no | yes | yes | yes
3398 Arguments :
3399 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3400 referenced in section 9.
3401
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003402 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003403 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003404 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3405 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003406
3407 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3408 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3409
3410 Example:
3411 listen
3412 bind *:80
3413
3414 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3415 filter compression
3416 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3417
3418 compression algo gzip
3419 compression offload
3420
3421 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3422
3423 See also : section 9.
3424
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003425
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003426fullconn <conns>
3427 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3429 yes | no | yes | yes
3430 Arguments :
3431 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3432 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3433
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003434 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003435 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003436 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003437 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3438 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3439 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3440 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3441 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003442 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003443
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003444 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3445 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003446 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3447 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3448 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003449
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003450 Example :
3451 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3452 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3453 # connections.
3454 backend dynamic
3455 fullconn 10000
3456 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3457 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3458
3459 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3460
3461
3462grace <time>
3463 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003465 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003466 Arguments :
3467 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3468 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3469 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3470
3471 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3472 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003473 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003474 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3475
3476 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3477 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3478 simplify it.
3479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003480
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003481hash-balance-factor <factor>
3482 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3484 yes | no | no | yes
3485 Arguments :
3486 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3487 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3488 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3489
3490 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3491 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3492 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3493 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3494 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3495 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3496 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3497
3498 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3499 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3500 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3501 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3502 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3503
3504 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3505
3506
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003507hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003508 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3510 yes | no | yes | yes
3511 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003512 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3513 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003514
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003515 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3516 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3517 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3518 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3519 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3520 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3521 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3522 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3523 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3524 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003525
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003526 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3527 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3528 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3529 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3530 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3531 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3532 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3533 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3534 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3535 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3536 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3537 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3538 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003539 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3540 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003541
3542 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3543
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003544 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003545 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3546 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3547 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003548 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3549 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3550 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003551
3552 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3553 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003554 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3555 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3556 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3557 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3558
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003559 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3560 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3561 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3562 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3563 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3564 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3565 parameter.
3566
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003567 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3568 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3569 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3570 used on strings.
3571
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003572 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3573
3574 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3575 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3576 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3577 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3578 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3579 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3580 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3581 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3582 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3583 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3584 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3585 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003586
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003587 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3588 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3589 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003590
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003591 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003592
3593
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594http-check disable-on-404
3595 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598 Arguments : none
3599
3600 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3601 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3602 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3603 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3604 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3605 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3606 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3607 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003608 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3609 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3610 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3611
3612 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3613
3614
3615http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003616 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003618 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003619 Arguments :
3620 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3621 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003622 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003623 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3624 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3625 details on the supported keywords.
3626
3627 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3628 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3629 with the usual backslash ('\').
3630
3631 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3632 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3633 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3634 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3635 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3636
3637 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003638 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003639 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3640 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3641 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3642
3643 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003644 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003645 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3646 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3647 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3648 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3649
3650 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003651 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003652 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3653 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3654 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3655 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3656 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3657 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3658 trace).
3659
3660 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003661 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003662 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3663 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3664 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3665 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3666 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3667 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3668
3669 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3670 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3671 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3672 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3673 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3674 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3675 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3676 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3677
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003678 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3679 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3680 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3681
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003682 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3683 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3684
3685 Examples :
3686 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003687 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003688
3689 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003690 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003691
3692 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003693 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003694
3695 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003696 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003697
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003698 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003699
3700
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003701http-check send-state
3702 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | no | yes | yes
3705 Arguments : none
3706
3707 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3708 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3709 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3710 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3711 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3712
3713 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3714 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3715 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3716 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3717 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003718 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3719 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3720 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3721
3722 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3723 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3724 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3725
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003726 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3727 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3728 checked in multiple backends.
3729
3730 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3731 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3732
3733 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3734 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3735 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3736 one fails.
3737
3738 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3739 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3740 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3741
3742 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3743 server's queue.
3744
3745 Example of a header received by the application server :
3746 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3747 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3748
3749 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3750
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003751http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3752 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003753 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003754 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003755 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003756 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3757 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003758 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3759 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003760 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3761 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3762 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003763 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003764 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003765 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003766 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003767 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003768 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003769 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003770 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003771 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003772 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3773
3774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 no | yes | yes | yes
3776
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003777 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3778 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3779 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3780 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3781 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003782
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003783 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3784 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3785 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3786
3787 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003788 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3789 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3790 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3791 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003792
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003793 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3794 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3795 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003796 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3797 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003798 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3799 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3800 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3801 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3802 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003803 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003804 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3805 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003806
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003807 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3808 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3809 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3810 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3811 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3812
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003813 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3814 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3815 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003816 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3817 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003818
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003819 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3820 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3821 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3822 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3823 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3824 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3825 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3826 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3827
3828 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3829 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3830 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003831 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3832 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003833
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003834 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3835 <name>.
3836
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003837 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3838 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3839 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3840 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3841 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3842 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3843 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3844 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3845
3846 Example:
3847
3848 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3849
3850 applied to:
3851
3852 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3853
3854 outputs:
3855
3856 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3857
3858 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3859
3860 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3861 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3862 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3863 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3864 header.
3865
3866 Example:
3867
3868 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3869
3870 applied to:
3871
3872 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3873
3874 outputs:
3875
3876 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3877
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003878 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3879 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3880 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3881 it.
3882
3883 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3884 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3885 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3886 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3887 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3888 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3889
3890 Example :
3891 # prepend the host name before the path
3892 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3893
3894 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3895 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3896 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3897 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3898 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3899 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3900 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3901 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3902
3903 Example :
3904 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3905 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3906
3907 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3908 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3909 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3910 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3911 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3912 "set-query".
3913
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003914 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3915 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3916 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3917 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3918 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3919 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3920 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3921 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3922
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003923 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3924 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3925 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3926 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3927 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3928 another equipment.
3929
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003930 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3931 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3932 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3933 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3934 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3935 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3936 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3937 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3938
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003939 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3940 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3941 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3942 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3943 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3944 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3945 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3946 admin privileges.
3947
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003948 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3949 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3950 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3951 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3952 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3953 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3954 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3955 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3956
3957 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3958 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3959 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3960 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3961 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3962 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3963
3964 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3965 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3966 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3967 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3968 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3969 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3970
3971 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3972 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3973 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3974 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3975 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3976 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3977 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3978 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3979 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3980
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003981 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003982 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3983 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3984 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3985 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3986 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3987 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3988 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3989 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3990 request header" for more information.
3991
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003992 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3993 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3994 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3995 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003996 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3997 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003998
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003999 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4000 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4001 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4002 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4003 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4004 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4005 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4006 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4007 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4008 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4009 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4010 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4011
4012 These actions take one or two arguments :
4013 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4014 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4015 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4016 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4017
4018 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4019 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4020 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4021 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4022
4023 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4024 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4025 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4026 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4027 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4028 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4029 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4030 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4031
4032 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4033 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4034 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4035 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4036 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4037
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004038 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4039 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4040 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4041 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4042 continues.
4043
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004044 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4045 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4046 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4047 the actions evaluation continues.
4048
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004049 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4050 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4051 inline.
4052
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004053 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4054 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004055 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004056 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4057 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004058 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004059 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004060 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004061 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4062 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004064 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004065 and '_'.
4066
4067 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4068 followed by some converters.
4069
4070 Example:
4071
4072 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4073
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004074 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4075 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4076
4077 Example:
4078
4079 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4080
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004081 - set-src <expr> :
4082 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4083 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4084 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4085 source IP for privacy.
4086
4087 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4088 followed by some converters.
4089
4090 Example:
4091
4092 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4093 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4094
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004095 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4096 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004097
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004098 - set-src-port <expr> :
4099 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4100 expression.
4101
4102 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4103 followed by some converters.
4104
4105 Example:
4106
4107 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4108 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4109
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004110 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4111 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4112 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004113
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004114 - set-dst <expr> :
4115 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4116 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4117 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4118 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4119 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4120
4121 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4122 followed by some converters.
4123
4124 Example:
4125
4126 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4127 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4128
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004129 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4130 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4131
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004132 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4133 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4134 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4135 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4136
4137 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4138 followed by some converters.
4139
4140 Example:
4141
4142 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4143 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4144
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004145 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4146 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4147 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4148
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004149 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4150 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4151 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4152 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4153 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4154 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4155 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4156 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4157 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4158 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4159 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4160 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4161 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4162 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4163 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4164 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4165
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004166 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4167 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4168 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4169
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004170 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4171
4172 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4173 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004174 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4175 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4176
4177 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4178 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4179 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4180 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004181
4182 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004183 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4184 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4185 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004186
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004187 http-request allow if nagios
4188 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4189 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4190 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004191
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004192 Example:
4193 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004194 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004195
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004196 Example:
4197 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4198 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004199 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004200 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4201 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4202 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4203 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4204 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4205 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4206
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004207 Example:
4208 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4209 acl add path /addacl
4210 acl del path /delacl
4211
4212 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4213
4214 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4215 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4216
4217 Example:
4218 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4219 acl setmap path /setmap
4220 acl delmap path /delmap
4221
4222 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4223
4224 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4225 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4226
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004227 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4228 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004229
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004230http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004231 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004232 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4234 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004235 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004236 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4237 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4238 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4239 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004240 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004241 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004242 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004243 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004244 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004245 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004246 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004247 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004248 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004249 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4250
4251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4252 no | yes | yes | yes
4253
4254 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4255 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4256 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4257 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4258 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4259 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4260
4261 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4262 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4263 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4264 current section.
4265
4266 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4267 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4268 rules are evaluated.
4269
4270 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4271 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4272 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4273 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4274 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4275 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4276 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4277
4278 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4279 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4280 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4281 external users.
4282
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004283 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4284 <name>.
4285
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004286 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4287 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4288 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4289 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4290 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4291 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4292 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4293 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4294
4295 Example:
4296
4297 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4298
4299 applied to:
4300
4301 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4302
4303 outputs:
4304
4305 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4306
4307 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4308
4309 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4310 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4311 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4312 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4313 header.
4314
4315 Example:
4316
4317 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4318
4319 applied to:
4320
4321 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4322
4323 outputs:
4324
4325 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4326
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004327 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004328 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4329 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4330 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004331
4332 Example:
4333
4334 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4335 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004336 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4337 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004338
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004339 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4340 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4341 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4342 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4343 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4344 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4345 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4346 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4347
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004348 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4349 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4350 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4351 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4352 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4353 another equipment.
4354
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004355 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4356 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4357 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4358 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4359 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4360 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4361 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4362 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4363
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004364 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4365 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4366 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4367 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4368 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4369 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4370 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4371 admin privileges.
4372
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004373 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4374 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4375 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4376 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4377 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4378 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4379 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4380 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4381
4382 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4383 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4384 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4385 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4386 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4387 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4388
4389 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4390 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4391 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4392 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4393 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4394 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4395
4396 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4397 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4398 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4399 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4400 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4401 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4402 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4403 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4404 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4405
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004406 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4407 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4408 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4409 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4410 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4411 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4412 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4413 response header" for more information.
4414
4415 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4416 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4417 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4418 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4419 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004420 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4421 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004422
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004423 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4424 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4425 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4426 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4427 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4428 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4429
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004430 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4431 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4432 inline.
4433
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004434 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4435 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004436 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004437 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4438 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004439 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004440 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004441 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004442 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4443 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004444 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004445 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4446 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004447
4448 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4449 followed by some converters.
4450
4451 Example:
4452
4453 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4454
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004455 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4456 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4457
4458 Example:
4459
4460 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4461
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004462 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4463 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4464 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4465 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4466 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4467 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4468 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4469
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004470 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4471 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4472 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4473 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4474 continues.
4475
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004476 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4477 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4478 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4479 the actions evaluation continues.
4480
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004481 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4482 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4483 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4484 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4485 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4486 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4487 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4488 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4489 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4490 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4491 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4492 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4493 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4494 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4495 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4496 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4497
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004498 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4499
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004500 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004501 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4502 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004503 rules.
4504
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004505 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4506 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4507 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4508 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4509
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004510 Example:
4511 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4512
4513 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4514
4515 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4516 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4517
4518 Example:
4519 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4520
4521 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4522
4523 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4524 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4525
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004526 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4527 ACL usage.
4528
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004529
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004530http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4531 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4532
4533 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4534 yes | no | yes | yes
4535
4536 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4537 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4538 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4539 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4540 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4541 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4542
4543 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4544
4545 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4546 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4547 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4548 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4549 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4550 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4551 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4552 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4553 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4554 not checking any request past the first one.
4555
4556 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4557 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4558 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4559 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4560 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4561 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4562 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4563
4564 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4565 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4566 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4567 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4568 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4569 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4570 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4571 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4572 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4573 downsides of rare connection failures.
4574
4575 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4576 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4577 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4578 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4579 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4580 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4581 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4582 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4583 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4584 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4585 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4586 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4587
4588 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4589 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4590 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4591 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4592
4593 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4594 and are never shared ;
4595
4596 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4597 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4598 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4599 and are never shared ;
4600
4601 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4602 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4603 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4604
4605 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4606 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4607 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4608
4609 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4610
4611
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004612http-send-name-header [<header>]
4613 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4614
4615 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4616 yes | no | yes | yes
4617
4618 Arguments :
4619
4620 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4621
4622 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4623 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4624 is added with the header string proved.
4625
4626 See also : "server"
4627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004628id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004629 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4631 no | yes | yes | yes
4632 Arguments : none
4633
4634 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4635 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4636 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004637
4638
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004639ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4640 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4641 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4642 no | yes | yes | yes
4643
4644 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4645 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4646 and running).
4647
4648 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4649 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4650 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004651 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004652 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4653
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004654 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4655 "unless" condition is met.
4656
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004657 Example:
4658 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4659 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4660 ignore-persist if url_static
4661
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004662 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4663
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004664load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4665 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4667 yes | no | yes | yes
4668
4669 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4670 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4671 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4672 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4673 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4674 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4675 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4676 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4677
4678 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4679 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004680 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004681
4682 Arguments:
4683 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4684 named "server-state-file".
4685
4686 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4687 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4688 name is used as a file name.
4689
4690 none don't load any stat for this backend
4691
4692 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004693 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4694 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4695 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4696 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4697 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004698
4699 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4700 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4701
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004702 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004703
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004704 global
4705 stats socket /tmp/socket
4706 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004707
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004708 defaults
4709 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004710
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004711 backend bk
4712 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4713 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004714
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004715
4716 Then one can run :
4717
4718 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4719
4720 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4721
4722 1
4723 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4724 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4725 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4726
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004727 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004728
4729 global
4730 stats socket /tmp/socket
4731 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4732
4733 defaults
4734 load-server-state-from-file local
4735
4736 backend bk
4737 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4738 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4739
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004740
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004741 Then one can run :
4742
4743 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4744
4745 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4746
4747 1
4748 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4749 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4750 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4751
4752 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4753 "show servers state"
4754
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004755
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004756log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004757log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004758no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004759 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004762
4763 Prefix :
4764 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4765 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4766 prefix does not allow arguments.
4767
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004768 Arguments :
4769 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4770 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4771 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4772 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4773 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4774 parameter.
4775
4776 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4777 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4778
4779 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4780 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4781 standard syslog port).
4782
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004783 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4784 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4785 standard syslog port).
4786
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004787 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4788 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4789 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4790 appropriately writeable).
4791
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004792 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4793 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004794
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004795 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4796 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4797 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4798 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4799 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4800 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4801 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4802 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4803 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4804 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4805 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4806
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004807 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4808
4809 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4810 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4811 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4812
4813 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4814 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4815 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004816 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4817 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4818 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4819 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4820 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004821
4822 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4823
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004824 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4825 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4826 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004827
4828 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4829 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4830 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4831 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4832
4833 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4834 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004835
4836 Example :
4837 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004838 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4839 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004840 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004841
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004842
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004843log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004844 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4846 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004847
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004848 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4849 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4850 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4851 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4852 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004853
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004854 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4855 "option httplog" directives.
4856
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004857log-format-sd <string>
4858 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4859 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4860 yes | yes | yes | no
4861
4862 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4863 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4864 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4865 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4866 which covers the log format string in depth.
4867
4868 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4869 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4870
4871 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4872 log format to "rfc5424".
4873
4874 Example :
4875 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4876
4877
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004878log-tag <string>
4879 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4881 yes | yes | yes | yes
4882
4883 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4884 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4885 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4886 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4887 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4888 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4889 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4890 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4891 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004892
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004893max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4894 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4896 yes | no | yes | yes
4897
4898 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4899 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4900 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4901 servers.
4902
4903 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4904 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4905 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4906 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4907 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4908 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4909 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4910 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4911 picking a different server.
4912
4913 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4914 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4915 even if they have to be queued.
4916
4917 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4918 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4919
4920
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004921maxconn <conns>
4922 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4924 yes | yes | yes | no
4925 Arguments :
4926 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4927 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4928 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4929 closes.
4930
4931 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4932 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4933 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4934 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004935 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4936 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4937 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4938 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004939
4940 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4941 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4942 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4943
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004944 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4945
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004946 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4947
4948
4949mode { tcp|http|health }
4950 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | yes | yes | yes
4953 Arguments :
4954 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4955 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4956 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4957 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4958
4959 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4960 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4961 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4962 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4963 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4964
4965 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004966 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4967 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4968 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4969 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4970 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4971 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4972 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004973
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004974 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4975 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4976 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004977
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004978 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004979 defaults http_instances
4980 mode http
4981
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004982 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004984
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004985monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004986 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004989 Arguments :
4990 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4991 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004992 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004993 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4994 backend and its backup.
4995
4996 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4997 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4998 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4999 servers in a list of backends.
5000
5001 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5002 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5003 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5004 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5005 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5006 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5007 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005008 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5009 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005010
5011 Example:
5012 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005013 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005014 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5015 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5016 monitor-uri /site_alive
5017 monitor fail if site_dead
5018
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005019 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005020
5021
5022monitor-net <source>
5023 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 yes | yes | yes | no
5026 Arguments :
5027 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5028 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5029 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5030 followed by a mask.
5031
5032 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5033 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005034 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005035 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5036
5037 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5038 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5039 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5040 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005041 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5042 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5043 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005044
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005045 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5046 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5047 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5048 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5049 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5050 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005051
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005052 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5053 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005054
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005055 Example :
5056 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5057 frontend www
5058 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5059
5060 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5061
5062
5063monitor-uri <uri>
5064 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | yes | yes | no
5067 Arguments :
5068 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5069 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5070
5071 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5072 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5073 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5074 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5075 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5076 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5077 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5078 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5079
5080 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5081 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5082 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5083 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5084 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5085 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5086
5087 Example :
5088 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5089 frontend www
5090 mode http
5091 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5092
5093 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005095
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005096option abortonclose
5097no option abortonclose
5098 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5100 yes | no | yes | yes
5101 Arguments : none
5102
5103 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5104 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5105 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5106 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005107 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005108 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5109 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5110 encountered while delivering the response.
5111
5112 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5113 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5114 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5115 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5116 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5117 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005118 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005119 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005120 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005121 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5122 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5123 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5124
5125 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5126 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5127 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5128 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5129 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5130 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5131 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5132 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005133 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005134
5135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5137
5138 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5139
5140
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005141option accept-invalid-http-request
5142no option accept-invalid-http-request
5143 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5145 yes | yes | yes | no
5146 Arguments : none
5147
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005148 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005149 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5150 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5151 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5152 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5153 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5154 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5155 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005156 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5157 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5158 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5159 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5160 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005161 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005162 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5163 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5164 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005165
5166 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5167 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5168 been confirmed.
5169
5170 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5171 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005172 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5173 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005174 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5175
5176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5178
5179 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5180 stats socket.
5181
5182
5183option accept-invalid-http-response
5184no option accept-invalid-http-response
5185 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | no | yes | yes
5188 Arguments : none
5189
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005190 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005191 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5192 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5193 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5194 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5195 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5196 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5197 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005198 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5199 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5200 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005201
5202 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5203 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5204 been confirmed.
5205
5206 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5207 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5208 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5209 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5210
5211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5213
5214 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5215 stats socket.
5216
5217
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005218option allbackups
5219no option allbackups
5220 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5222 yes | no | yes | yes
5223 Arguments : none
5224
5225 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5226 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5227 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5228 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5229 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5230 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5231 order between the backup servers anymore.
5232
5233 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5234 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5235
5236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5238
5239
5240option checkcache
5241no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005242 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 yes | no | yes | yes
5245 Arguments : none
5246
5247 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5248 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005249 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005250 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5251 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005252 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005253
5254 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005255 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005256 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005257 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5258 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005259 to the client are :
5260 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005261 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005262 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005263 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5264 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5265 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5266 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5267 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5268 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5269 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5270 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5271 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5272 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5273 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5274
5275 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005276 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005277 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005278 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005279 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5280
5281 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5282 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005283 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005284 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5285
5286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5288
5289
5290option clitcpka
5291no option clitcpka
5292 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5294 yes | yes | yes | no
5295 Arguments : none
5296
5297 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5298 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5299 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5300 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5301
5302 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5303 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5304 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5305 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5306
5307 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5308 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5309 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5310 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5311 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5312
5313 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5314
5315 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5316 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5317 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5318
5319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5321
5322 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5323
5324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005325option contstats
5326 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | yes | yes | no
5329 Arguments : none
5330
5331 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5332 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5333 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5334 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005335 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5336 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5337 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5338 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5339 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005340
5341
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005342option dontlog-normal
5343no option dontlog-normal
5344 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5346 yes | yes | yes | no
5347 Arguments : none
5348
5349 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5350 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5351 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5352 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5353 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5354 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5355 logged.
5356
5357 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5358 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5359 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005361 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005362 logging.
5363
5364
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005365option dontlognull
5366no option dontlognull
5367 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5369 yes | yes | yes | no
5370 Arguments : none
5371
5372 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5373 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5374 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5375 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5376 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5377 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005378 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5379 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5380 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005381
5382 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5383 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5384 would not be logged.
5385
5386 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5387 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5388
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005389 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5390 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005391
5392
5393option forceclose
5394no option forceclose
5395 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005397 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005398 Arguments : none
5399
5400 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5401 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5402 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5403 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5404 global session times in the logs.
5405
5406 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005407 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005408 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005409
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005410 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5411 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5412 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5413
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005414 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5415 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005416
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5419
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005420 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005421
5422
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005423option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005424 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 yes | yes | yes | yes
5427 Arguments :
5428 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5429 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005430 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005431 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005432
5433 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5434 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5435 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5436 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5437 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5438 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5439 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005440 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5441 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5442 possible that the client has already brought one.
5443
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005444 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005445 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005446 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5447 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005448 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5449 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005450
5451 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5452 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5453 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5454 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5455 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5456 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5457 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5458
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005459 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5460 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5461 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5462 are under the control of the end-user.
5463
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005464 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005465 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5466 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005467 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5468 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5469 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005470
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005471 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005472 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5473 frontend www
5474 mode http
5475 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5476
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005477 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5478 backend www
5479 mode http
5480 option forwardfor header X-Client
5481
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005482 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005483 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005484
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005485
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005486option http-buffer-request
5487no option http-buffer-request
5488 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5490 yes | yes | yes | yes
5491 Arguments : none
5492
5493 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5494 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5495 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5496 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5497 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5498 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5499 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5500 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005501 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005502 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5503 default.
5504
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005505 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005506
5507
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005508option http-ignore-probes
5509no option http-ignore-probes
5510 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5512 yes | yes | yes | no
5513 Arguments : none
5514
5515 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5516 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5517 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5518 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5519 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5520 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5521 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5522 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5523 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5524 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5525 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5526 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5527
5528 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5529 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5530 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5531 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5532 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5533 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5534 are often the only way to detect them.
5535
5536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5538
5539 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5540
5541
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005542option http-keep-alive
5543no option http-keep-alive
5544 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5546 yes | yes | yes | yes
5547 Arguments : none
5548
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005549 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5550 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5551 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5552 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5553 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5554 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5555 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5556
5557 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5558 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005559 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5560 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5561 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5562 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5563 situations where this option may be useful :
5564
5565 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5566 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5567
5568 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5569 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5570
5571 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5572 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5573 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5574 request.
5575
5576 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5577 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005578 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5579 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5580 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005581
5582 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5583 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5584
5585 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5586 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5587 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5588 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5589 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5590 not set.
5591
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005592 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5593 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005594 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005595 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005596
5597 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005598 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5599 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005600
5601
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005602option http-no-delay
5603no option http-no-delay
5604 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 yes | yes | yes | yes
5607 Arguments : none
5608
5609 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5610 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5611 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5612 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5613 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5614 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5615 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5616 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5617 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5618 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5619 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5620 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5621 affected.
5622
5623 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5624 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5625 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5626 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5627 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5628 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5629 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5630 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5631 latency environments.
5632
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005633 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5634
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005635
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005636option http-pretend-keepalive
5637no option http-pretend-keepalive
5638 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5640 yes | yes | yes | yes
5641 Arguments : none
5642
5643 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5644 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5645 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5646 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5647 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5648 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5649 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5650 consider the response complete.
5651
5652 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5653 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5654 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5655 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5656 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5657 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5658
5659 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5660 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5661 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5662 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5663 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5664 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5665 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5666
5667 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5668 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005669 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005670 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5671 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005672
5673 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5674 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5675
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005676 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5677 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005678
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005679
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005680option http-server-close
5681no option http-server-close
5682 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5684 yes | yes | yes | yes
5685 Arguments : none
5686
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005687 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5688 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5689 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5690 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5691 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5692 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5693 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5694 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5695 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5696 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5697 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005698 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005699 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5700 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5701 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5702 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005703
5704 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5705 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5706 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5707 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005708 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5709 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005710
5711 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5712 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005713 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5714 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005715 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5716 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005717
5718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5720
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005721 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005722 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5723 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005724
5725
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005726option http-tunnel
5727no option http-tunnel
5728 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5730 yes | yes | yes | yes
5731 Arguments : none
5732
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005733 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5734 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5735 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5736 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5737 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5738 "option http-tunnel".
5739
5740 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005741 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005742 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5743 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5744 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5745 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5746 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5747 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5748 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005749
5750 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5751 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5752
5753 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5754 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5755 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5756
5757
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005758option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005759no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005760 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5762 yes | yes | yes | no
5763 Arguments : none
5764
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005765 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005766 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5767 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5768 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5769 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5770 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5771 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5772
5773 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5774 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005775 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5776 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5777 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005778
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005779 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5780 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5781 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5782 front of an existing proxy.
5783
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005784 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5785
5786 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5787 http-server-close".
5788
5789
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005790option httpchk
5791option httpchk <uri>
5792option httpchk <method> <uri>
5793option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5794 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5796 yes | no | yes | yes
5797 Arguments :
5798 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5799 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5800 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5801 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5802 ones.
5803
5804 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5805 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5806 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5807
5808 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5809 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5810 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5811 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5812 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5813
5814 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5815 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5816 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5817 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5818 the lack of any response.
5819
5820 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5821
5822 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5823 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5824 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5825
5826 Examples :
5827 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5828 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5829 backend https_relay
5830 mode tcp
5831 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5832 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5833
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005834 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5835 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5836 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005837
5838
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005839option httpclose
5840no option httpclose
5841 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5843 yes | yes | yes | yes
5844 Arguments : none
5845
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005846 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5847 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5848 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5849 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005850 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005851 "option http-tunnel".
5852
5853 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5854 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5855 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5856 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5857 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5858 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5859 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5860 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005861
5862 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005863 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005864 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5865 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5866 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5867 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5868 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005869
5870 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5871 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005872 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5873 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005874 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5875 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005876
5877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5879
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005880 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5881 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005882
5883
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005884option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005885 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005888 Arguments :
5889 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5890 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5891 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5892 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5893 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005894
5895 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5896 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5897 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5898 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5899 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5900 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5901 ports.
5902
5903 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5904
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005905 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5906 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005907
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005908 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005910 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005911
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005912
5913option http_proxy
5914no option http_proxy
5915 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5917 yes | yes | yes | yes
5918 Arguments : none
5919
5920 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5921 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5922 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5923 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5924 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5925
5926 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5927 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005928 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5929 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005930
5931 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5932 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5933
5934 Example :
5935 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5936 backend direct_forward
5937 option httpclose
5938 option http_proxy
5939
5940 See also : "option httpclose"
5941
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005942
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005943option independent-streams
5944no option independent-streams
5945 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | yes | yes | yes
5948 Arguments : none
5949
5950 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5951 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5952 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5953 receive data or not.
5954
5955 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5956 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5957 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5958 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5959 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5960 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5961 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5962 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5963 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5964 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5965 socket buffers.
5966
5967 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5968 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5969 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5970 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5971 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5972
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005973 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005974 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5975 deprecated.
5976
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005977 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005978
5979
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005980option ldap-check
5981 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5983 yes | no | yes | yes
5984 Arguments : none
5985
5986 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5987 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5988 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5989 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5990
5991 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5992 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5993
5994 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5995 configure it.
5996
5997 Example :
5998 option ldap-check
5999
6000 See also : "option httpchk"
6001
6002
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006003option external-check
6004 Use external processes for server health checks
6005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6006 yes | no | yes | yes
6007
6008 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6009 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6010 command".
6011
6012 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6013
6014 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6015
6016
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006017option log-health-checks
6018no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006019 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6021 yes | no | yes | yes
6022 Arguments : none
6023
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006024 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6025 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6026 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006027
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006028 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6029 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6030 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6031 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6032 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6033
6034 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6035 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006036
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006037 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6038 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6039 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006040
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006041
6042option log-separate-errors
6043no option log-separate-errors
6044 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 yes | yes | yes | no
6047 Arguments : none
6048
6049 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6050 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6051 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6052 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6053 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6054 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6055 provides very important information.
6056
6057 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6058 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6059 error logs.
6060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006061 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006062 logging.
6063
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006064
6065option logasap
6066no option logasap
6067 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6069 yes | yes | yes | no
6070 Arguments : none
6071
6072 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6073 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6074 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6075 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6076 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6077 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6078 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006079 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006080 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6081 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6082
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006083 Examples :
6084 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6085 mode http
6086 option httplog
6087 option logasap
6088 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6089
6090 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6091 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6092 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6093 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006095 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006096 logging.
6097
6098
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006099option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006100 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6102 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006103 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006104 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6105 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006106 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006107
6108 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6109 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6110 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6111 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6112 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6113 in the MySQL table, like this :
6114
6115 USE mysql;
6116 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6117 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6118
6119 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6120 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6121 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6122 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6123 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6124 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6125 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6126 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6127 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6128
6129 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6130 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006131
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006132 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006133
6134 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6135 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6136 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6137 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006138 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6139 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006140
6141 See also: "option httpchk"
6142
6143
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006144option nolinger
6145no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006146 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6148 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006149 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006150
6151 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6152 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6153 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6154 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6155 connections.
6156
6157 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6158 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6159 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6160 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6161 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6162 this too.
6163
6164 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6165 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6166 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6167
6168 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6169 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6170 for servers.
6171
6172 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6173 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6174
6175
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006176option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6177 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6179 yes | yes | yes | yes
6180 Arguments :
6181 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6182 matching <network>
6183 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6184 header name.
6185
6186 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6187 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6188 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6189 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6190 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6191 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6192 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6193 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6194 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6195 possible that the client has already brought one.
6196
6197 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6198 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6199 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6200 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6201 header and requires different one.
6202
6203 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6204 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6205 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6206 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6207 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6208 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6209 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6210
6211 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6212 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6213 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6214 both are defined.
6215
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006216 Examples :
6217 # Original Destination address
6218 frontend www
6219 mode http
6220 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6221
6222 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6223 backend www
6224 mode http
6225 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6226
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006227 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6228 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006229
6230
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006231option persist
6232no option persist
6233 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6235 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006236 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006237
6238 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6239 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6240 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6241 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6242 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6243 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6244 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6245 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6246 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6247 redirected to another valid server.
6248
6249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6251
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006252 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006253
6254
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006255option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6256 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6258 yes | no | yes | yes
6259 Arguments :
6260 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6261 PostgreSQL server.
6262
6263 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6264 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6265 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6266 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6267
6268 See also: "option httpchk"
6269
6270
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006271option prefer-last-server
6272no option prefer-last-server
6273 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6274 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6275 yes | no | yes | yes
6276 Arguments : none
6277
6278 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6279 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6280 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6281 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6282 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6283 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6284 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6285 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6286 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006287 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6288 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6289 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6290 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6291 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6292 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6293 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006294
6295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6297
6298 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6299
6300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006301option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006302option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006303no option redispatch
6304 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006307 Arguments :
6308 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6309 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6310 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6311 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6312 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6313 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6314 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6315 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6316 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006318
6319 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6320 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6321 be able to access the service anymore.
6322
6323 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6324 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6325
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006326 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006327 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6328 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006330 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6331 "redisp" keywords.
6332
6333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6335
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006336 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006337
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006338
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006339option redis-check
6340 Use redis health checks for server testing
6341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6342 yes | no | yes | yes
6343 Arguments : none
6344
6345 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6346 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6347 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6348 find the "+PONG" response message.
6349
6350 Example :
6351 option redis-check
6352
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006353 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006354
6355
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006356option smtpchk
6357option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6358 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006361 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006362 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6363 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6364 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6365
6366 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6367 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6368 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6369
6370 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6371 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6372 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6373 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6374 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6375 dead server.
6376
6377 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6378 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6379 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6380 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6381
6382 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6383 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6384 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6385 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006386 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006387
6388 Example :
6389 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6390
6391 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006394option socket-stats
6395no option socket-stats
6396
6397 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | yes | yes | no
6400
6401 Arguments : none
6402
6403
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006404option splice-auto
6405no option splice-auto
6406 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6408 yes | yes | yes | yes
6409 Arguments : none
6410
6411 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6412 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6413 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6414 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006415 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006416 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6417 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6418 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6419 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6420
6421 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6422 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6423 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6424 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6425 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6426 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6427 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6428 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6429 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6430 keyword.
6431
6432 Example :
6433 option splice-auto
6434
6435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6437
6438 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6439 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6440
6441
6442option splice-request
6443no option splice-request
6444 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6446 yes | yes | yes | yes
6447 Arguments : none
6448
6449 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006450 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006451 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6452 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6453 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6454 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6455
6456 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6457
6458 Example :
6459 option splice-request
6460
6461 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6462 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6463
6464 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6465 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6466
6467
6468option splice-response
6469no option splice-response
6470 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6472 yes | yes | yes | yes
6473 Arguments : none
6474
6475 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006476 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006477 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6478 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6479 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6480 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6481
6482 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6483
6484 Example :
6485 option splice-response
6486
6487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6489
6490 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6491 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6492
6493
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006494option spop-check
6495 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6497 no | no | no | yes
6498 Arguments : none
6499
6500 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6501 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6502 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6503 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6504
6505 Example :
6506 option spop-check
6507
6508 See also : "option httpchk"
6509
6510
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006511option srvtcpka
6512no option srvtcpka
6513 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 yes | no | yes | yes
6516 Arguments : none
6517
6518 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6519 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6520 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6521 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6522
6523 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6524 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6525 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6526 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6527
6528 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6529 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6530 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6531 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6532 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6533
6534 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6535
6536 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6537 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6538 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6539
6540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6542
6543 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6544
6545
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006546option ssl-hello-chk
6547 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6549 yes | no | yes | yes
6550 Arguments : none
6551
6552 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6553 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6554 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6555 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6556 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6557 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6558 hello message.
6559
6560 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6561 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6562 messages, which is appreciable.
6563
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006564 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6565 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6566 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006567
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006568 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6569
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006570
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006571option tcp-check
6572 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6573 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | no | yes | yes
6575
6576 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6577 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6578
6579 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6580 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6581 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6582
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006583 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006584 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6585 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6586 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6587 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6588 only.
6589
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006590 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006591 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6592 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6593 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6594 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6595
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006596 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006597 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6598 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006599 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006600 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6601 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6602 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6603 the respective protocols.
6604 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6605 analysed.
6606
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006607 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6608 script.
6609
6610 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6611 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6612 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6613 The "comment" is of course optional.
6614
6615
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006616 Examples :
6617 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6618 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006619 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006620
6621 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6622 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006623 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006624
6625 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6626 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006627 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006628 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006629 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006630 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006631 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006632 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006633 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6634 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006635 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006636 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6637 tcp-check expect string +OK
6638
6639 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6640 (send many headers before analyzing)
6641 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006642 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006643 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6644 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6645 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6646 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006647 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006648
6649
6650 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6651
6652
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006653option tcp-smart-accept
6654no option tcp-smart-accept
6655 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | yes | yes | no
6658 Arguments : none
6659
6660 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6661 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6662 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6663 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6664 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6665 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6666
6667 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6668 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6669 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6670 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6671
6672 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6673 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6674 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6675 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6676
6677 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6678 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6679 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6680
6681 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6682 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6683 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6684
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006685 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6686
6687
6688option tcp-smart-connect
6689no option tcp-smart-connect
6690 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 yes | no | yes | yes
6693 Arguments : none
6694
6695 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6696 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6697 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6698 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6699 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6700
6701 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6702 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6703 complex.
6704
6705 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6706 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6707 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6708
6709 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6710 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6711
6712 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6713
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006714
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006715option tcpka
6716 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6718 yes | yes | yes | yes
6719 Arguments : none
6720
6721 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6722 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6723 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6724 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6725
6726 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6727 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6728 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6729 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6730
6731 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6732 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6733 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6734 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6735 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6736
6737 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6738
6739 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6740 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6741 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6742 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6743 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6744 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6745 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6746 backends.
6747
6748 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6749
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006750
6751option tcplog
6752 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 yes | yes | yes | yes
6755 Arguments : none
6756
6757 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6758 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6759 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6760 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6761 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6762 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6763 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6764 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6765
6766 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6767
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006768 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006770 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006771
6772
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006773option transparent
6774no option transparent
6775 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006777 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006778 Arguments : none
6779
6780 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6781 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6782 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6783 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6784 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6785 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6786 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6787 appropriate server.
6788
6789 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6790 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6791
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006792 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006793 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006794
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006795
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006796external-check command <command>
6797 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6799 yes | no | yes | yes
6800
6801 Arguments :
6802 <command> is the external command to run
6803
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006804 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6805
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006806 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006807
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006808 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6809 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6810 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6811 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6812 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6813 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006814
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006815 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6816
6817 Environment variables :
6818 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6819 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6820
6821 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6822
6823 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6824
6825 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6826 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6827 for a UNIX socket).
6828
6829 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6830
6831 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6832
6833 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6834
6835 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6836
6837 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6838
6839 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6840 socket).
6841
6842 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6843 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6844
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006845 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6846 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6847 failed.
6848
6849 Example :
6850 external-check command /bin/true
6851
6852 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6853
6854
6855external-check path <path>
6856 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 yes | no | yes | yes
6859
6860 Arguments :
6861 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6862
6863 The default path is "".
6864
6865 Example :
6866 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6867
6868 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6869 "external-check command"
6870
6871
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006872persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006873persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006874 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6876 yes | no | yes | yes
6877 Arguments :
6878 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006879 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6880 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006881
6882 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6883 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6884 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6885 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6886 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6887 forwarded to this server.
6888
6889 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6890 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6891 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006892 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006893 a single "listen" section.
6894
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006895 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6896 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6897 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6898
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006899 Example :
6900 listen tse-farm
6901 bind :3389
6902 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6903 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6904 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6905 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6906 persist rdp-cookie
6907 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006908 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006909 balance rdp-cookie
6910 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6911 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6912
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006913 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6914 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006915
6916
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006917rate-limit sessions <rate>
6918 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 yes | yes | yes | no
6921 Arguments :
6922 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6923 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6924
6925 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6926 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6927 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6928 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6929 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6930 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6931
6932 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6933 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6934 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6935 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6936
6937 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6938 listen smtp
6939 mode tcp
6940 bind :25
6941 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006942 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006943
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006944 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6945 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6946 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006947
6948 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6949
6950
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006951redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6952redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6953redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006954 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6956 no | yes | yes | yes
6957
6958 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006959 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006960
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006961 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006962 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006963 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6964 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6965 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006966
6967 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6968 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6969 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6970 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6971 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006972 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6973 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6974 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6975 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006976
6977 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6978 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6979 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6980 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6981 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6982 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006983 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006984 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006985 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6986 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6987 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006988
6989 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006990 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6991 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6992 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006993 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006994 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6995 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6996 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6997 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006998
6999 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7000 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7001
7002 - "drop-query"
7003 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7004 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7005 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7006 with a location-type redirect.
7007
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007008 - "append-slash"
7009 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7010 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7011 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7012 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7013
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007014 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7015 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7016 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7017 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7018 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7019 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7020 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7021
7022 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7023 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7024 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7025 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7026 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7027 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7028 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007029
7030 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7031 acl clear dst_port 80
7032 acl secure dst_port 8080
7033 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007034 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007035 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007036 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7037
7038 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007039 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7040 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7041 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007042 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007043
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007044 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7045 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7046 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7047
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007048 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007049 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007050
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007051 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007052 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7053 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7054 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007056 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007057
7058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007059redisp (deprecated)
7060redispatch (deprecated)
7061 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7063 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007064 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007065
7066 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7067 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7068 be able to access the service anymore.
7069
7070 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7071 redistribute them to a working server.
7072
7073 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7074 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7075 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007077 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7078 "option redispatch" instead.
7079
7080 See also : "option redispatch"
7081
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007082
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007083reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007084 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7086 no | yes | yes | yes
7087 Arguments :
7088 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7089 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007090 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007091
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007092 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7093 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7094
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007095 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7096 the last header of an HTTP request.
7097
7098 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7099 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7100 responses.
7101
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007102 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7103 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7104 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7105
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007106 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7107 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007108
7109
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007110reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7111reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007112 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7114 no | yes | yes | yes
7115 Arguments :
7116 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7117 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7118 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7119 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7120 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7121 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7122 ignores case.
7123
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007124 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7125 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7126
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007127 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7128 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7129 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7130 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007131 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007132
7133 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7134 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7135
7136 Example :
7137 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7138 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7139 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7140
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007141 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7142 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007143
7144
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007145reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7146reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007147 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7149 no | yes | yes | yes
7150 Arguments :
7151 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7152 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7153 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7154 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7155 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7156 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7157
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007158 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7159 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7160
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007161 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7162 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7163 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7164 next servers.
7165
7166 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7167 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7168 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7169
7170 Example :
7171 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7172 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7173 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7174
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007175 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7176 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007177
7178
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007179reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7180reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007181 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7183 no | yes | yes | yes
7184 Arguments :
7185 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7186 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7187 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7188 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7189 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7190 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7191 case.
7192
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007193 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7194 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7195
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007196 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7197 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7198 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7199 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007200 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007201
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007202 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007203 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007204 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007205
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007206 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7207 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7208
7209 Example :
7210 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7211 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7212 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7213
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007214 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7215 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007216
7217
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007218reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7219reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007220 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 no | yes | yes | yes
7223 Arguments :
7224 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7225 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7226 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7227 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7228 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7229 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7230 case.
7231
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007232 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7233 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7234
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007235 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7236 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7237 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7238 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7239
7240 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7241 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7242
7243 Example :
7244 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7245 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7246 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7247 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7248
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007249 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7250 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007251
7252
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007253reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7254reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007255 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7257 no | yes | yes | yes
7258 Arguments :
7259 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7260 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7261 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7262 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7263 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7264 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7265
7266 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7267 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7268 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7269 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007270 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007271
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007272 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7273 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7274
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007275 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7276 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7277 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7278
7279 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7280 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7281 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7282 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7283 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7284
7285 Example :
7286 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007287 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007288 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7289 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7290
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007291 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7292 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007293
7294
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007295reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7296reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007297 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 no | yes | yes | yes
7300 Arguments :
7301 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7302 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7303 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7304 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7305 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7306 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7307 ignores case.
7308
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007309 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7310 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7311
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007312 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7313 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007314 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7315 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7316 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007317 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7318 not set.
7319
7320 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7321 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7322 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7323 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7324 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7325
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007326 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007327 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7328 # block all others.
7329 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7330 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7331
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007332 # block bad guys
7333 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7334 reqitarpit . if badguys
7335
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007336 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7337 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007338
7339
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007340retries <value>
7341 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7342 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | no | yes | yes
7344 Arguments :
7345 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7346 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7347 default value is 3.
7348
7349 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7350 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7351 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7352
7353 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007354 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7355 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007356
7357 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7358 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7359
7360 See also : "option redispatch"
7361
7362
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007363rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007364 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 no | yes | yes | yes
7367 Arguments :
7368 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7369 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007370 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007371
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007372 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7373 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7374
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007375 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7376 the last header of an HTTP response.
7377
7378 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7379 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7380 responses.
7381
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007382 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7383 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007384
7385
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007386rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7387rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007388 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 no | yes | yes | yes
7391 Arguments :
7392 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7393 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7394 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7395 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7396 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7397 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7398 ignores case.
7399
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007400 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7401 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7402
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007403 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7404 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007405 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007406 client.
7407
7408 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7409 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7410 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7411
7412 Example :
7413 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007414 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007415
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007416 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7417 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007418
7419
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007420rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7421rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007422 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7424 no | yes | yes | yes
7425 Arguments :
7426 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7427 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7428 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7429 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7430 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7431 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7432 ignores case.
7433
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007434 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7435 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7436
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007437 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7438 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7439 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7440 case-sensitive.
7441
7442 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007443 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7444 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7445 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007446
7447 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7448 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7449
7450 Example :
7451 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7452 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7453
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007454 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7455 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007456
7457
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007458rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7459rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007460 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7462 no | yes | yes | yes
7463 Arguments :
7464 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7465 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7466 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7467 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7468 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7469 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7470 ignores case.
7471
7472 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7473 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7474 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7475 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007476 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007477
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007478 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7479 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7480
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007481 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7482 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7483 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7484
7485 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7486 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7487 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7488 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7489 are not case-sensitive.
7490
7491 Example :
7492 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7493 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7494
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007495 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7496 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007497
7498
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007499server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007500 Declare a server in a backend
7501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 no | no | yes | yes
7503 Arguments :
7504 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007505 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007506 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007507
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007508 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7509 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7510 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7511 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007512 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7513 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7514 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7515 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7516 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007517 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7518 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7519 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7520 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7521 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7522 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7523 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007524 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007525 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7526 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007527 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7528 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007530 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007531 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7532 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7533 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7534 adding this value to the client's port.
7535
7536 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7537 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007538 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007539
7540 Examples :
7541 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7542 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007543 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007544 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7545 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7546 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007547
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007548 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7549 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7550 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7551 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7552 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7553
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007554 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7555 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007556
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007557server-state-file-name [<file>]
7558 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7559 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7560 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7561 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7562 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7563 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7564
7565 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7566 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7567
7568 global
7569 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7570
7571 backend bk
7572 load-server-state-from-file
7573
7574 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7575 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007576
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007577server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7578 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7579 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7581 no | no | yes | yes
7582
7583 Arguments:
7584 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7585
7586 <num | range>
7587 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7588 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7589 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7590 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7591
7592 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7593
7594 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7595
7596 <params*>
7597 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7598 keyword.
7599
7600 Examples:
7601 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7602 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7603 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7604
7605 # or
7606 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7607
7608 # would be equivalent to:
7609 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7610 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7611 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7612
7613
7614
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007615source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007616source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007617source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007618 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 yes | no | yes | yes
7621 Arguments :
7622 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7623 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007624
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007625 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007626 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7627 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7628 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7629 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7630 supported prefixes are :
7631 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7632 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7633 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007634 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007635 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7636 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007637
7638 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7639 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007640 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7641 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7642 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007643
7644 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7645 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7646 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7647 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7648 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7649 <addr>.
7650
7651 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7652 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7653 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7654 port.
7655
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007656 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7657 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7658 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7659 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007660 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007661 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7662 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7663 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7664 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7665 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7666 HTTP header.
7667
7668 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7669 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007670 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007671 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7672 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7673 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7674 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7675 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7676 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7677 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7678
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007679 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7680 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7681 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7682 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7683 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7684 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7685
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007686 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7687 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7688 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7689 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7690
7691 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7692 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7693 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7694 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7695 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7696 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7697
7698 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7699 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7700 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7701 there are two methods :
7702
7703 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7704 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7705 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7706 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7707 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7708 of the client ranges may be used.
7709
7710 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7711 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7712 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7713 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7714 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7715 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7716 same session.
7717
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007718 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7719 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7720 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007721 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007722
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007723 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007725 Examples :
7726 backend private
7727 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7728 source 192.168.1.200
7729
7730 backend transparent_ssl1
7731 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7732 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7733
7734 backend transparent_ssl2
7735 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7736 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7737 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7738
7739 backend transparent_ssl3
7740 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7741 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7742 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7743
7744 backend transparent_smtp
7745 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7746 # with Tproxy version 4.
7747 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7748
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007749 backend transparent_http
7750 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7751 # proxy.
7752 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007754 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007755 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007757
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007758srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7759 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7761 yes | no | yes | yes
7762 Arguments :
7763 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7764 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7765 as explained at the top of this document.
7766
7767 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7768 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7769 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7770 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7771 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7772 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7773 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7774
7775 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7776 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7777 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7778 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7779 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007780 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007781 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007782 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007783
7784 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7785 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7786 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7787 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7788 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7789 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7790
7791 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7792 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7793
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007794 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7795 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007796
7797
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007798stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7799 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007801 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007802
7803 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7804 matched.
7805
7806 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7807 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7808
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007809 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7810 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7811 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7812
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007813 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7814 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7815 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7816 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007817
7818 Example :
7819 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7820 backend stats_localhost
7821 stats enable
7822 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7823
7824 Example :
7825 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7826 backend stats_auth
7827 stats enable
7828 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7829 stats admin if TRUE
7830
7831 Example :
7832 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7833 userlist stats-auth
7834 group admin users admin
7835 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7836 group readonly users haproxy
7837 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7838
7839 backend stats_auth
7840 stats enable
7841 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7842 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7843 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7844 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7845
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007846 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7847 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7848 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007849
7850
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007851stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7852 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007854 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007855 Arguments :
7856 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7857
7858 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7859
7860 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7861 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7862 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7863 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7864 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7865 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7866
7867 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7868 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7869 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007870 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007871
7872 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7873 report using "stats scope".
7874
7875 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7876 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7877 unobvious parameters.
7878
7879 Example :
7880 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7881 backend public_www
7882 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7883 stats enable
7884 stats hide-version
7885 stats scope .
7886 stats uri /admin?stats
7887 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7888 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7889 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7890
7891 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7892 backend private_monitoring
7893 stats enable
7894 stats uri /admin?stats
7895 stats refresh 5s
7896
7897 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7898
7899
7900stats enable
7901 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007903 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007904 Arguments : none
7905
7906 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7907 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7908 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7909 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7910 - stats auth : no authentication
7911 - stats scope : no restriction
7912
7913 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7914 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7915 unobvious parameters.
7916
7917 Example :
7918 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7919 backend public_www
7920 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7921 stats enable
7922 stats hide-version
7923 stats scope .
7924 stats uri /admin?stats
7925 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7926 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7927 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7928
7929 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7930 backend private_monitoring
7931 stats enable
7932 stats uri /admin?stats
7933 stats refresh 5s
7934
7935 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7936
7937
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007938stats hide-version
7939 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007941 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007942 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007944 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7945 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7946 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7947 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7948 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7949 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007951 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7952 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7953 unobvious parameters.
7954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007955 Example :
7956 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7957 backend public_www
7958 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007959 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007960 stats hide-version
7961 stats scope .
7962 stats uri /admin?stats
7963 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7964 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7965 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007966
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007967 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7968 backend private_monitoring
7969 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007970 stats uri /admin?stats
7971 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007972
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007973 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007974
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007975
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007976stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7977 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7978 Access control for statistics
7979
7980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7981 no | no | yes | yes
7982
7983 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7984 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7985 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7986 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7987 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7988 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7989
7990 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7991 instance.
7992
7993 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7994 about ACL usage.
7995
7996
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007997stats realm <realm>
7998 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008000 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008001 Arguments :
8002 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8003 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8004 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8005
8006 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8007 using a backslash ('\').
8008
8009 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8010 only related to authentication.
8011
8012 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8013 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8014 unobvious parameters.
8015
8016 Example :
8017 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8018 backend public_www
8019 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8020 stats enable
8021 stats hide-version
8022 stats scope .
8023 stats uri /admin?stats
8024 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8025 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8026 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8027
8028 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8029 backend private_monitoring
8030 stats enable
8031 stats uri /admin?stats
8032 stats refresh 5s
8033
8034 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8035
8036
8037stats refresh <delay>
8038 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008040 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008041 Arguments :
8042 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8043 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8044 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8045 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8046 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8047 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8048
8049 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8050 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8051 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8052 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8053
8054 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8055 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8056 unobvious parameters.
8057
8058 Example :
8059 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8060 backend public_www
8061 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8062 stats enable
8063 stats hide-version
8064 stats scope .
8065 stats uri /admin?stats
8066 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8067 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8068 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8069
8070 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8071 backend private_monitoring
8072 stats enable
8073 stats uri /admin?stats
8074 stats refresh 5s
8075
8076 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8077
8078
8079stats scope { <name> | "." }
8080 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008082 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008083 Arguments :
8084 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8085 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8086 section in which the statement appears.
8087
8088 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8089 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8090 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8091 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8092 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8093 exists.
8094
8095 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8096 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8097 unobvious parameters.
8098
8099 Example :
8100 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8101 backend public_www
8102 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8103 stats enable
8104 stats hide-version
8105 stats scope .
8106 stats uri /admin?stats
8107 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8108 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8109 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8110
8111 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8112 backend private_monitoring
8113 stats enable
8114 stats uri /admin?stats
8115 stats refresh 5s
8116
8117 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8118
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008119
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008120stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008121 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008123 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008124
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008125 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008126 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8127
8128 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8129 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8130
8131 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8132 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008133 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008134
8135 Example :
8136 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8137 backend private_monitoring
8138 stats enable
8139 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8140 stats uri /admin?stats
8141 stats refresh 5s
8142
8143 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8144 global section.
8145
8146
8147stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008148 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | yes | yes | yes
8151 Arguments : none
8152
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008153 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008154 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8155 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8156 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8157 - IP (socket, server)
8158 - cookie (backend, server)
8159
8160 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8161 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008162 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008163
8164 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8165
8166
8167stats show-node [ <name> ]
8168 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008170 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008171 Arguments:
8172 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8173 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8174
8175 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8176 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008177 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008178
8179 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8180 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8181 unobvious parameters.
8182
8183 Example:
8184 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8185 backend private_monitoring
8186 stats enable
8187 stats show-node Europe-1
8188 stats uri /admin?stats
8189 stats refresh 5s
8190
8191 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8192 section.
8193
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008194
8195stats uri <prefix>
8196 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008198 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008199 Arguments :
8200 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8201 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8202 query string.
8203
8204 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8205 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8206 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8207 possible to reach it in the application.
8208
8209 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008210 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008211 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8212 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8213 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8214 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8215
8216 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8217 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8218 an address or a port to statistics only.
8219
8220 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8221 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8222 unobvious parameters.
8223
8224 Example :
8225 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8226 backend public_www
8227 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8228 stats enable
8229 stats hide-version
8230 stats scope .
8231 stats uri /admin?stats
8232 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8233 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8234 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8235
8236 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8237 backend private_monitoring
8238 stats enable
8239 stats uri /admin?stats
8240 stats refresh 5s
8241
8242 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8243
8244
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008245stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8246 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008248 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008249
8250 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008251 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008252 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8253 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8254 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8255
8256 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8257 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8258 the "stick-table" statement.
8259
8260 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8261 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8262 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8263 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8264 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8265
8266 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8267 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8268 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8269 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8270 transformation rules.
8271
8272 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8273 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8274 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8275 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8276 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8277 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8278 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8279
8280 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8281 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8282 ACL based conditions.
8283
8284 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8285 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8286 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8287 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8288
8289 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8290 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8291 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8292 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8293
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008294 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8295 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8296 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8297
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008298 Example :
8299 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8300 # last 30 minutes
8301 backend pop
8302 mode tcp
8303 balance roundrobin
8304 stick store-request src
8305 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8306 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8307 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8308
8309 backend smtp
8310 mode tcp
8311 balance roundrobin
8312 stick match src table pop
8313 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8314 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8315
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008316 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008317 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008318
8319
8320stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8321 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8323 no | no | yes | yes
8324
8325 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8326 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8327 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8328 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8329
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008330 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8331 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8332 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8333
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008334 Examples :
8335 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008336 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008337
8338 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8339 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8340 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8341
8342
8343 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8344 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8345 backend http
8346 mode http
8347 balance roundrobin
8348 stick on src table https
8349 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8350 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8351 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8352
8353 backend https
8354 mode tcp
8355 balance roundrobin
8356 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8357 stick on src
8358 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8359 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8360
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008361 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008362
8363
8364stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8365 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8367 no | no | yes | yes
8368
8369 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008370 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008371 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8372 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8373 server is selected.
8374
8375 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8376 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8377 the "stick-table" statement.
8378
8379 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8380 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8381 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8382 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8383 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8384 address.
8385
8386 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8387 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8388 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8389 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8390 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8391 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8392 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8393 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8394 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8395 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8396
8397 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8398 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8399 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8400 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8401 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8402 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8403 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8404
8405 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8406 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8407 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8408 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8409
8410 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8411 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8412 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8413 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8414 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8415 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008416 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8417 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8418 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8419 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8420 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8421 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008422
8423 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8424 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8425 the request.
8426
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008427 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8428 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8429 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8430
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008431 Example :
8432 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8433 # last 30 minutes
8434 backend pop
8435 mode tcp
8436 balance roundrobin
8437 stick store-request src
8438 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8439 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8440 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8441
8442 backend smtp
8443 mode tcp
8444 balance roundrobin
8445 stick match src table pop
8446 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8447 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8448
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008449 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008450 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008451
8452
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008453stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008454 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8455 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008456 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008458 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008459
8460 Arguments :
8461 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8462 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8463 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8464 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8465
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008466 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8467 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8468 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8469 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8470
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008471 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8472 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8473 instance.
8474
8475 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8476 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8477 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8478 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8479 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8480 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008481 to 32 characters.
8482
8483 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8484 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8485 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008486 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008487 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8488 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008489
8490 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008491 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8492 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008493 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8494 increase.
8495
8496 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008497 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8498 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8499 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008500
8501 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8502 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8503 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8504 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8505 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8506 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8507 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8508 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8509 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8510 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8511 parameter (see below).
8512
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008513 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8514 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8515 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8516 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8517 soft restart.
8518
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008519 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8520 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008521
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008522 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8523 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8524 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8525 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008526 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008527 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008528 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8529 if not expiration delay is specified.
8530
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008531 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8532 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8533 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8534 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008535 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8536 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8537 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8538 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8539 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8540 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8541 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8542 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8543 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8544 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8545 types and their arguments.
8546
8547 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8548 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8549 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8550 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8551
8552 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8553 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8554 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8555 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8556
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008557 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8558 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8559 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8560 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8561 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8562 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8563
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008564 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8565 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8566 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8567 they were received.
8568
8569 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8570 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8571 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8572 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8573 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8574
8575 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8576 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8577 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8578 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8579 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8580
8581 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8582 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8583 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8584
8585 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8586 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8587 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8588 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8589 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8590
8591 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8592 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8593 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8594 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8595 the client side.
8596
8597 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8598 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8599 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8600 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8601 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8602 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8603 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8604
8605 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8606 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8607 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8608 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8609 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8610 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8611 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8612
8613 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8614 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8615 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8616 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8617 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8618 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8619
8620 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8621 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8622 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8623 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8624
8625 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8626 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8627 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8628 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8629 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8630 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8631 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8632 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8633 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8634 recommended for better fairness.
8635
8636 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8637 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8638 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8639 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8640
8641 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8642 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8643 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8644 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8645 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8646 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8647 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8648 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8649 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8650 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008651
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008652 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8653 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008654 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8655 reference it.
8656
8657 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8658 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008659 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8660 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8661 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008662
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008663 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8664 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8665 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8666 something that can be ignored.
8667
8668 Example:
8669 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8670 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8671 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8672 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8673
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008674 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008675 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008676
8677
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008678stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008679 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8681 no | no | yes | yes
8682
8683 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008684 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008685 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8686 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8687 server is selected.
8688
8689 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8690 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8691 the "stick-table" statement.
8692
8693 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8694 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8695 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8696 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8697
8698 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8699 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8700 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8701 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8702 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8703 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008704 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008705 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8706 rules.
8707
8708 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8709 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8710 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8711 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8712 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8713 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8714 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8715
8716 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8717 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8718 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8719 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8720
8721 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8722 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8723 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8724 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8725 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8726 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008727 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8728 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8729 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8730 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8731 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8732 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8733 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8734 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8735 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008736
8737 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8738
8739 Example :
8740 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8741 backend https
8742 mode tcp
8743 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008744 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008745 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008746
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008747 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8748 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8749
8750 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8751 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8752 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8753
8754 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8755 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008756
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008757 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8758 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8759 # at offset 44.
8760
8761 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8762 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8763
8764 # Learn on response if server hello.
8765 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008766
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008767 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8768 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8769
8770 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8771 extraction.
8772
8773
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008774tcp-check connect [params*]
8775 Opens a new connection
8776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8777 no | no | yes | yes
8778
8779 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8780 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8781 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8782
8783 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8784 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8785 of the sequence.
8786
8787 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8788 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8789 do.
8790
8791 Parameters :
8792 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8793 use the TCP connection.
8794
8795 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8796 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8797 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8798
8799 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8800
8801 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8802
8803 Examples:
8804 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8805 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8806 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8807 option tcp-check
8808 tcp-check connect
8809 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8810 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8811 tcp-check send \r\n
8812 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8813 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8814 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8815 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8816 tcp-check send \r\n
8817 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8818 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8819
8820 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8821 option tcp-check
8822 tcp-check connect port 110
8823 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8824 tcp-check connect port 143
8825 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8826 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8827
8828 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8829
8830
8831tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8832 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8834 no | no | yes | yes
8835
8836 Arguments :
8837 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8838 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8839 binary.
8840 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8841 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8842 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8843
8844 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8845 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8846 with the usual backslash ('\').
8847 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8848 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8849 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8850 used upper or lower case.
8851
8852
8853 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8854
8855 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8856 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8857 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8858 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8859 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8860 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8861 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8862 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8863
8864 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8865 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8866 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8867 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8868 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8869 expression.
8870
8871 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8872 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8873 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8874 this exact hexadecimal string.
8875 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8876
8877 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8878 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8879 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8880 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8881 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8882 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8883 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8884 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8885 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8886 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8887 the null character.
8888
8889 Examples :
8890 # perform a POP check
8891 option tcp-check
8892 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8893
8894 # perform an IMAP check
8895 option tcp-check
8896 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8897
8898 # look for the redis master server
8899 option tcp-check
8900 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008901 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008902 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8903 tcp-check expect string role:master
8904 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8905 tcp-check expect string +OK
8906
8907
8908 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8909 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8910
8911
8912tcp-check send <data>
8913 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8915 no | no | yes | yes
8916
8917 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8918 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8919
8920 Examples :
8921 # look for the redis master server
8922 option tcp-check
8923 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8924 tcp-check expect string role:master
8925
8926 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8927 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8928
8929
8930tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8931 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8932 tcp health check
8933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8934 no | no | yes | yes
8935
8936 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8937 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8938 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8939 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8940 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8941 hexadecimal string.
8942 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8943
8944 Examples :
8945 # redis check in binary
8946 option tcp-check
8947 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8948 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8949
8950
8951 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8952 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8953
8954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008955tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8956 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8958 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008959 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008960 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8961 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008963 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008964
8965 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8966 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008967 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8968 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8969 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8970 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8971 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8972 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008974 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8975 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8976 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8977 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008978
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008979 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008980 - accept :
8981 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8982 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8983 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008984
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008985 - reject :
8986 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8987 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8988 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8989 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8990 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8991 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8992 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8993 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8994 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8995 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8996 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008997 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008998
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008999 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9000 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9001 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9002 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9003 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9004 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9005 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9006 hosts.
9007
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009008 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9009 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9010 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9011 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9012 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9013 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9014 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9015 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9016
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009017 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9018 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9019 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9020 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9021 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9022 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9023 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9024 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9025 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009026 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9027 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009028
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009029 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009030 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009031 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009032 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009033 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9034 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009035 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009036 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9037 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9038 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9039 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9040 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009042 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009043 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009044 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009045 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9046 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9047 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9048 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009049
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009050 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9051 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9052 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9053 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009055 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9056 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9057 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9058 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9059 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009060 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9061 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9062 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9063 layer7 information is extracted.
9064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009065 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9066 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9067 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9068 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9069 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009070
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009071 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9072 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9073 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9074 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9075
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009076 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9077 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9078 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9079 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9080 continues.
9081
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009082 - set-src <expr> :
9083 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9084 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9085 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9086 set-src"
9087
9088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9089 followed by some converters.
9090
9091 Example:
9092
9093 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9094
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009095 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9096 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009097
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009098 - set-src-port <expr> :
9099 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9100 expression.
9101
9102 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9103 followed by some converters.
9104
9105 Example:
9106
9107 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9108
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009109 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9110 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9111 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009112
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009113 - set-dst <expr> :
9114 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9115 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9116 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9117 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9118 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9119
9120 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9121 followed by some converters.
9122
9123 Example:
9124
9125 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9126 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9127
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009128 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9129 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9130
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009131 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9132 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9133 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9134 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9135
9136
9137 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9138 followed by some converters.
9139
9140 Example:
9141
9142 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9143
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009144 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9145 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9146 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9147
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009148 - "silent-drop" :
9149 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9150 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9151 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9152 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9153 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9154 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9155 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9156 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9157 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9158 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9159 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9160 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9161 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9162 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9163 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9164 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009166 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9167 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9168 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009170 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9171 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9172 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009174 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009175 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009176 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009177
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009178 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9179 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9180 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009182 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009183 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9184 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009185
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009186 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9187
9188 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9189
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009190 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9191
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009192 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009193
9194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009195tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9196 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009198 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009199 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009200 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9201 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009203 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009205 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9206 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9207 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9208 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9209 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009210
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009211 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9212 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9213 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9214 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009215 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9216 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9217 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9218 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9219 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9220 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009221 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009222 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009224 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9225 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9226 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9227 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009228
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009229 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009230 - accept : the request is accepted
9231 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9232 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009233 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009234 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009235 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009236 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009237 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009238 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009240 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9241 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009242
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009243 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9244 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9245 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9246 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9247 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9248 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009250 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009251 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9252 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009254 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009255 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9256 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9257 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9258 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009259 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9260 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9261 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009262
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009263 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009264 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9265 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9266 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009267
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009268 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009269 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9270 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009271
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009272 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9273 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009274 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009275 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9276 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009277 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009278 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009279 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009280 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9281 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009282 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009283 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9284 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009285
9286 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9287 followed by some converters.
9288
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009289 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9290 <var-name>.
9291
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009292 Example:
9293
9294 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009295 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009296
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009297 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009298 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9299 # and reject everything else.
9300 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9301 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009302 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009303 tcp-request content reject
9304
9305 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009306 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9307 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9308 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009309 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009310
9311 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9312 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9313 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009314 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009315 tcp-request content reject
9316
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009317 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009318 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009319 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009320 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009321 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9322 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009323
9324 Example:
9325 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9326 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009327 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009329 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009330 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009331
9332 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009333 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009334 # protecting all our sites
9335 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009336 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9337 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009338 ...
9339 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9340
9341 backend http_dynamic
9342 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009343 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009344 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009345 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009346 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009347 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009348 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009349
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009350 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009351
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009352 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9353 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009354
9355
9356tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9357 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009359 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009360 Arguments :
9361 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9362 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9363 as explained at the top of this document.
9364
9365 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9366 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9367 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9368 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9369 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9370
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009371 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9372 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9373 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9374 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9375
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009376 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9377 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009378 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009379 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009380 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9381 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9382 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9383 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009384
9385 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9386 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9387 it pass through unaffected.
9388
9389 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9390 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9391 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009392 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009393 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9394 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009395 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9396 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9397 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009398
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009399 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009400 "timeout client".
9401
9402
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009403tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9404 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9406 no | no | yes | yes
9407 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009408 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9409 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009410
9411 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9412
9413 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9414 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9415 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009416 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9417 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009418
9419 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9420
9421 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9422 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9423 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9424 inserted.
9425
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009426 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009427 - accept :
9428 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9429 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9430 the rules evaluation.
9431
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009432 - close :
9433 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9434 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9435 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9436 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9437 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9438 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009439 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009440 protocols.
9441
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009442 - reject :
9443 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9444 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009445 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009446
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009447 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9448 Sets a variable.
9449
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009450 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9451 Unsets a variable.
9452
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009453 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9454 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9455 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9456 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9457
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009458 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9459 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9460 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9461 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9462 continues.
9463
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009464 - "silent-drop" :
9465 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9466 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9467 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9468 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9469 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9470 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9471 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9472 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9473 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9474 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9475 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9476 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9477 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9478 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9479 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9480 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9481
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009482 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9483 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9484 for changing the default action to a reject.
9485
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009486 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9487 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9488 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9489 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009490 period.
9491
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009492 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9493 declared inline.
9494
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009495 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9496 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009497 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009498 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9499 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009500 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009501 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009502 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009503 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9504 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009505 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009506 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9507 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009508
9509 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9510 followed by some converters.
9511
9512 Example:
9513
9514 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9515
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009516 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9517 <var-name>.
9518
9519 Example:
9520
9521 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9522
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009523 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9524
9525 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9526
9527
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009528tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9529 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9531 no | yes | yes | no
9532 Arguments :
9533 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9534 below.
9535
9536 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9537
9538 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9539 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9540 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9541 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9542 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9543 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9544 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9545 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9546 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9547 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9548 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9549 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9550 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9551 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9552 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9553 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9554 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9555 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9556 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9557 instead.
9558
9559 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9560 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9561 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9562 rules which may be inserted.
9563
9564 Several types of actions are supported :
9565 - accept : the request is accepted
9566 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9567 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9568 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9569 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9570 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009571 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009572 - silent-drop
9573
9574 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9575 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9576 sections for a complete description.
9577
9578 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9579 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9580 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9581
9582 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9583 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9584 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9585 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9586 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9587
9588 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9589 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9590
9591 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9592 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9593 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9594
9595 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9596 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9597 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9598
9599 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9600 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9601 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9602
9603 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9604 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9605 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9606
9607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9608
9609 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9610
9611
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009612tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9613 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 no | no | yes | yes
9616 Arguments :
9617 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9618 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9619 as explained at the top of this document.
9620
9621 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9622
9623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009624timeout check <timeout>
9625 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9626 established.
9627
9628 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9629 yes | no | yes | yes
9630 Arguments:
9631 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9632 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9633 as explained at the top of this document.
9634
9635 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9636 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9637 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9638 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009639 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9640 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9641 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009642
9643 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9644 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9645
9646 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9647 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009648 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009649
9650 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9651 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9652 forget about it.
9653
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009654 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9655 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009656
9657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009658timeout client <timeout>
9659timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9660 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9662 yes | yes | yes | no
9663 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009664 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009665 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9666 as explained at the top of this document.
9667
9668 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9669 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9670 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009671 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9672 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9673 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9674 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009675 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9676 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9677 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009678 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009679 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009680 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9681 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009682 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9683 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009684
9685 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9686 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9687 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9688 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9689 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9690 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9691
9692 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9693 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9694 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9695
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009696 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9697 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009698
9699
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009700timeout client-fin <timeout>
9701 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9703 yes | yes | yes | no
9704 Arguments :
9705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9707 as explained at the top of this document.
9708
9709 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9710 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9711 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9712 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9713 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9714 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9715 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9716 down in one direction.
9717
9718 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9719 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9720 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9721
9722 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9723
9724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009725timeout connect <timeout>
9726timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9727 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9729 yes | no | yes | yes
9730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009731 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9733 as explained at the top of this document.
9734
9735 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009736 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009737 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009738 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009739 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9740 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009741
9742 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9743 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9744 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9745 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9746 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9747 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9748
9749 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9750 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9751 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9752
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009753 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9754 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009755
9756
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009757timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9758 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9760 yes | yes | yes | yes
9761 Arguments :
9762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9764 as explained at the top of this document.
9765
9766 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9767 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9768 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9769 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9770 once the request has started to present itself.
9771
9772 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9773 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9774 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9775 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9776 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9777
9778 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9779 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9780 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9781 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9782
9783 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9784 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9785 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9786 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9787 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009788 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009789
9790 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9791 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9792 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9793 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9794
9795 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9796
9797
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009798timeout http-request <timeout>
9799 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009801 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009802 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009803 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009804 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9805 as explained at the top of this document.
9806
9807 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9808 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9809 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9810 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9811 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9812 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9813 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009814 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9815 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9816 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9817 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9818 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009819 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9820 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009821
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009822 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9823 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9824 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9825 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9826 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009827 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009828
9829 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9830 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9831 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9832 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9833 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9834
9835 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009836 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9837 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9838 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009839
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009840 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009841 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009842
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009843
9844timeout queue <timeout>
9845 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9847 yes | no | yes | yes
9848 Arguments :
9849 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9850 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9851 as explained at the top of this document.
9852
9853 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9854 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9855 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9856 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9857 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9858
9859 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9860 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9861 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9862 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9863
9864 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9865
9866
9867timeout server <timeout>
9868timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9869 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9871 yes | no | yes | yes
9872 Arguments :
9873 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9874 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9875 as explained at the top of this document.
9876
9877 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9878 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9879 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9880 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9881 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9882 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9883 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9884
9885 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9886 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9887 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9888 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9889 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009890 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009891 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009892 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9893 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9894 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9895 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009896
9897 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9898 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9899 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9900 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9901 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9902 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9903
9904 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9905 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9906 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9907
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009908 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009909
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009910
9911timeout server-fin <timeout>
9912 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9914 yes | no | yes | yes
9915 Arguments :
9916 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9917 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9918 as explained at the top of this document.
9919
9920 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9921 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9922 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9923 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9924 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9925 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9926 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9927 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9928 situations, it should not be needed.
9929
9930 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9931 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9932 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9933
9934 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9935
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009936
9937timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009938 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9940 yes | yes | yes | yes
9941 Arguments :
9942 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9943 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9944 as explained at the top of this document.
9945
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009946 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9947 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9948 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9949 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009950
9951 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9952 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9953 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9954 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009955 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009956
9957 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9958
9959
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009960timeout tunnel <timeout>
9961 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9963 yes | no | yes | yes
9964 Arguments :
9965 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9966 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9967 as explained at the top of this document.
9968
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009969 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009970 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9971 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9972 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9973 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9974 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9975 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9976 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9977 specified.
9978
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009979 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9980 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9981 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9982 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9983 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9984 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9985 state.
9986
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009987 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9988 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9989 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9990 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9991 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9992
9993 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9994 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9995 forget about it.
9996
9997 Example :
9998 defaults http
9999 option http-server-close
10000 timeout connect 5s
10001 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010002 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010003 timeout server 30s
10004 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10005
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010006 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010007
10008
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010009transparent (deprecated)
10010 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010012 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010013 Arguments : none
10014
10015 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10016 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10017 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10018 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10019 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10020 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10021 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10022 appropriate server.
10023
10024 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10025
10026 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10027 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10028
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010029 See also: "option transparent"
10030
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010031unique-id-format <string>
10032 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10034 yes | yes | yes | no
10035 Arguments :
10036 <string> is a log-format string.
10037
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010038 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10039 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10040 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10041 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010042
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010043 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10044 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10045 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10046 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10047 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10048 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10049 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10050 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010051
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010052 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10053 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010054
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010055 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010056
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010057 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010058
10059 will generate:
10060
10061 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10062
10063 See also: "unique-id-header"
10064
10065unique-id-header <name>
10066 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10068 yes | yes | yes | no
10069 Arguments :
10070 <name> is the name of the header.
10071
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010072 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10073 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010074
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010075 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010076
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010077 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010078 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10079
10080 will generate:
10081
10082 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10083
10084 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010085
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010086use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010087 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10089 no | yes | yes | no
10090 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010091 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10092 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010093
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010094 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10095 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010096
10097 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10098 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10099 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010100 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10101 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10102 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10103 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010104
10105 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10106 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10107 assign the backend.
10108
10109 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10110 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10111 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10112 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10113 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10114 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10115
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010116 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010117 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010118 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10119 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10120 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10121
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010122 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10123 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10124 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10125 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10126 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10127 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10128 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10129 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10130 cannot be forced from the request.
10131
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010132 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010133 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10134 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10135
10136 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10137 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010138
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010139
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010140use-server <server> if <condition>
10141use-server <server> unless <condition>
10142 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10144 no | no | yes | yes
10145 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010146 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010147
10148 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10149
10150 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10151 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10152 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10153
10154 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10155 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10156 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10157 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10158 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10159 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10160 matches will assign the server.
10161
10162 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10163 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10164 with the next rules until one matches.
10165
10166 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10167 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10168 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10169 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10170
10171 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10172 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10173 stripped.
10174
10175 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10176 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10177 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10178 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10179
10180 Example :
10181 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10182 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10183 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10184 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10185 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10186 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010187 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010188 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10189 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10190
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010191 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010192
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010193
101945. Bind and Server options
10195--------------------------
10196
10197The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10198depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10199settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10200written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10201described in this section.
10202
10203
102045.1. Bind options
10205-----------------
10206
10207The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10208as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10209no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10210parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10211while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10212provided immediately after the setting name.
10213
10214The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10215
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010216accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10217 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10218 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10219 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10220 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10221 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10222 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10223 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10224 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10225 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010226 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10227 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10228 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010230accept-proxy
10231 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010232 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10233 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010234 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10235 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10236 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10237 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10238 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10239 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10240 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010241 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10242 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010243
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010244allow-0rtt
10245 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10246 due to security considerations.
10247
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010248alpn <protocols>
10249 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10250 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10251 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10252 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10253 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10254 initial NPN extension.
10255
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010256backlog <backlog>
10257 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10258 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10259
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010260curves <curves>
10261 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10262 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10263 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10264 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10265 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10266 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10267
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010268ecdhe <named curve>
10269 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010270 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10271 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010272
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010273ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10275 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10276 client's certificate.
10277
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010278ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10280 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10281 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10282 error is ignored.
10283
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010284ca-sign-file <cafile>
10285 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10286 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10287 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10288 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10289 'generate-certificates' for details.
10290
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010291ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10293 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10294 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10295 'generate-certificates' for details.
10296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010297ciphers <ciphers>
10298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10299 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010300 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010301 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10302 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010303 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10304 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10305 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10306 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010307
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010308crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10310 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10311 to verify client's certificate.
10312
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010313crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10315 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10316 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10317 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10318 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10319 file.
10320
10321 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10322 are loaded.
10323
10324 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010325 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010326 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10327 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10328 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10329 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10330 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10331 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10332 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010333
10334 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10335 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10336 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10337 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010338 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10339 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010340
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010341 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010342
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010343 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10344 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010345 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010346 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10347 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10348 clients).
10349
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010350 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10351 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10352 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10353 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10354 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10355 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10356 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10357 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10358 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10359 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10360 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10361 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10362 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10363
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010364 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10365 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10366 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10367 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10368 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10369
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010370 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10371 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10372 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10373 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010374
10375 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10376 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10377 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10378 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10379 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10380 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10381 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10382 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10383 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10384
10385 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10386
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010387 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010388 a cert bundle.
10389
10390 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10391 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10392 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10393 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10394 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10395 provide multi-cert support.
10396
10397 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10398
10399 Filename | CN | SAN
10400 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10401 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010402 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010403 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10404 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10405
10406 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10407 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10408 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10409 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010410 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10411 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10412 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010413
10414 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10415 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10416
10417 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10418 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10419 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10420
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010421crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10423 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010424 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010425 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010426
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010427crt-list <file>
10428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010429 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10430 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010431
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010432 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10433
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010434 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10435 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010436 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010437 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010438
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010439 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10440 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10441 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10442 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10443 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10444 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10445 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10446 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010447
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010448 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010449 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010450 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10451 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10452 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010453
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010454 crt-list file example:
10455 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010456 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010457 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010458 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010460defer-accept
10461 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10462 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10463 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10464 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10465 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10466 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10467 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10468 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10469 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10470 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10471 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10472
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010473expose-fd listeners
10474 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10475 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010476 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10477 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010478 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10479
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010480force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010481 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010482 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010483 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010484 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010485
10486force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010487 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010488 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010489 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010490
10491force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010492 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010493 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010494 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010495
10496force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010497 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010498 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010499 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010500
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010501force-tlsv13
10502 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10503 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010504 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010505
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010506generate-certificates
10507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10508 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10509 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10510 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10511 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10512 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10513 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10514 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10515 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10516 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10517 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10518
10519 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10520 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10521 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10522 certificate is used many times.
10523
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010524gid <gid>
10525 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10526 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10527 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10528 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10529 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10530
10531group <group>
10532 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10533 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10534 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10535 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10536 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10537
10538id <id>
10539 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10540 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10541 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10542 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10543
10544interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010545 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10546 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10547 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10548 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10549 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10550 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10551 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010552
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010553level <level>
10554 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10555 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10556 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10557 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10558 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10559 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10560 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10561 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10562 counters).
10563 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10564 all counters).
10565
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010566severity-output <format>
10567 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10568 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10569 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10570 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10571 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10572 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10573 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10574 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10575 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10576 rfc5424 convention.
10577
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010578maxconn <maxconn>
10579 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10580 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10581 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10582 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10583 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10584 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10585 eat all memory.
10586
10587mode <mode>
10588 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10589 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10590 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10591 UNIX sockets.
10592
10593mss <maxseg>
10594 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10595 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10596 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10597 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10598 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10599 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10600 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10601 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10602 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10603 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10604 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10605
10606name <name>
10607 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10608 page.
10609
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010610namespace <name>
10611 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10612 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10613 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10614 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10615
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010616nice <nice>
10617 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10618 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10619 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10620 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10621 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10622 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10623 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10624 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10625 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10626 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10627 one for an RDP socket.
10628
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010629no-ca-names
10630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10631 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10632
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010633no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010634 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010635 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010636 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010637 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010638 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10639 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010640
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010641no-tls-tickets
10642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10643 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10644 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010645 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10646 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010647
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010648no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010650 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010651 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010652 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010653 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10654 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010655
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010656no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010658 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010659 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010660 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010661 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10662 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010663
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010664no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010665 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010666 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010667 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010668 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010669 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10670 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010671
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010672no-tlsv13
10673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10674 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10675 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10676 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010677 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10678 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010679
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010680npn <protocols>
10681 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10682 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10683 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10684 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010685 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10686 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010687
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010688prefer-client-ciphers
10689 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10690 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10691 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10692
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010693process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10694 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10695 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10696 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10697 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10698 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10699 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10700 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010701 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10702 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10703 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10704 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10705 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10706 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10707 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010708
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010709ssl
10710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010711 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010712 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10713 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010714 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10715 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010716
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010717ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10718 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10719 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10720 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10721
10722ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10723 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10724 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10725 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10726
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010727strict-sni
10728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10729 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10730 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10731 See the "crt" option for more information.
10732
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010733tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010734 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010735 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10736 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010737 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010738 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10739 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10740 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10741 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10742 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10743 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10744 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10745
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010746tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010747 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010748 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10749 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10750 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10751 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10752 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10753 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10754 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010755 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10756 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10757 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010758
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010759tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10760 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10761 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10762 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10763 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10764 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10765 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10766 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10767 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10768 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10769 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10770
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010771transparent
10772 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10773 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10774 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10775 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10776 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10777 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10778 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10779 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10780 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10781 so check for support with your vendor.
10782
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010783v4v6
10784 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10785 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10786 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10787 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010788 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010789
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010790v6only
10791 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10792 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10793 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010794 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10795 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010796
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010797uid <uid>
10798 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10799 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10800 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10801 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10802 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10803
10804user <user>
10805 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10806 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10807 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10808 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10809 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10810
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010811verify [none|optional|required]
10812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10813 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10814 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10815 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10816 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010817 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10818 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10819 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10820 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010821
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200108225.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010823------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010825The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10826which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10827arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10828settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10829after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10830Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10831address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010833 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010834 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010835
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010836Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10837keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010839The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010840
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010841addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010842 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010843 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10844 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10845 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10846 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10847 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010848
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010849agent-check
10850 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010851 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10852 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10853 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10854 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010855
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010856 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010857 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010858 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10859 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10860 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010861
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010862 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10863 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10864 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10865 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10866 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10867
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010868 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10869 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010870
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010871 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10872 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10873 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010874
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010875 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10876 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10877 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010878
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010879 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10880 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10881 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10882 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10883 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10884 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10885 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010886
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010887 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10888 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010889
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010890 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10891 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10892 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10893 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10894 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10895 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10896 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10897 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10898 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010899
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010900 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10901 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010902 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10903 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10904 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010905 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010906
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010907 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010908 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010909
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010910agent-send <string>
10911 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10912 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10913 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10914 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10915 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10916
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010917agent-inter <delay>
10918 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10919 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10920
10921 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10922 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10923 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10924 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10925 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10926 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10927 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10928 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10929 of backends use the same servers.
10930
10931 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10932
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010933agent-addr <addr>
10934 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10935
10936 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10937 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10938 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10939 hostname, it will be resolved.
10940
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010941agent-port <port>
10942 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10943
10944 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010946backup
10947 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10948 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10949 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10950 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010951 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10952 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010953
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010954ca-file <cafile>
10955 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10956 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10957 server's certificate.
10958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010959check
10960 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010961 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10962 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10963 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10964 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10965 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10966 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10967 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010968 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10969 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010970 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10971 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010972
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010973check-send-proxy
10974 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10975 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10976 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10977 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10978 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10979 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10980 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10981
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020010982check-sni
10983 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
10984 over SSL.
10985
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010986check-ssl
10987 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10988 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10989 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10990 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010991 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010992 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10993 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10994 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010995 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10996 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010997
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010998ciphers <ciphers>
10999 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011000 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011001 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11002 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11003 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11004 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11005 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11006 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011008cookie <value>
11009 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11010 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11011 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11012 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11013 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11014 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11015 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11016
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011017crl-file <crlfile>
11018 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11019 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11020 to verify server's certificate.
11021
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011022crt <cert>
11023 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11024 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11025 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11026 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11027 certificate request.
11028
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011029disabled
11030 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11031 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11032 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11033 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11034 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011035 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011036
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011037enabled
11038 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11039 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11040 default value.
11041 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11042 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011044error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011045 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11046 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11047 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011049 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011051fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011052 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11053 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11054 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11055
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011056force-sslv3
11057 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11058 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011059 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011060 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011061
11062force-tlsv10
11063 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011064 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011065 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011066
11067force-tlsv11
11068 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011069 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011070 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011071
11072force-tlsv12
11073 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011074 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011075 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011076
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011077force-tlsv13
11078 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11079 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011080 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011082id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011083 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11084 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11085 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011086
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011087init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11088 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11089 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11090 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11091 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11092 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11093 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11094 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11095 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11096 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11097 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11098 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11099 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11100 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11101 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11102 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11103 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11104 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11105 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11106 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11107 historic behaviour.
11108
11109 Example:
11110 defaults
11111 # never fail on address resolution
11112 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011114inter <delay>
11115fastinter <delay>
11116downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011117 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11118 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11119 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11120 between checks depending on the server state :
11121
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011122 Server state | Interval used
11123 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11124 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11125 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11126 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11127 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11128 or yet unchecked. |
11129 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11130 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11131 | "inter" otherwise.
11132 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011134 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11135 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11136 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11137 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011138 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11139 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11140 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11141 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11142 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011144maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011145 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11146 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11147 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11148 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11149 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11150 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11151 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11152 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011154maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011155 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11156 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11157 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11158 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11159 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11160 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11161 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011163minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011164 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11165 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11166 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11167 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11168 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11169 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011170 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011171 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011172
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011173namespace <name>
11174 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11175 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11176 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11177 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11178
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011179no-agent-check
11180 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11181 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11182 default value.
11183 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11184 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11185
11186no-backup
11187 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11188 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11189 default value.
11190 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11191 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11192
11193no-check
11194 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11195 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11196 default value.
11197 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11198 "default-server" "check" setting.
11199
11200no-check-ssl
11201 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11202 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11203 default value.
11204 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11205 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11206
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011207no-send-proxy
11208 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11209 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11210 default value.
11211 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11212 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11213
11214no-send-proxy-v2
11215 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11216 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11217 default value.
11218 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11219 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11220
11221no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11222 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11223 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11224 default value.
11225 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11226 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11227
11228no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11229 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11230 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11231 default value.
11232 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11233 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11234
11235no-ssl
11236 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11237 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11238 default value.
11239 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11240 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11241
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011242no-ssl-reuse
11243 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11244 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11245 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11246 and for paranoid users.
11247
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011248no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011249 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11250 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011251 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011252
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011253 Supported in default-server: No
11254
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011255no-tls-tickets
11256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11257 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11258 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011259 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11260 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011261 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011262
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011263no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011264 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011265 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11266 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011267 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11268 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011269 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011270
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011271 Supported in default-server: No
11272
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011273no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011274 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011275 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11276 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011277 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11278 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011279 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011280
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011281 Supported in default-server: No
11282
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011283no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011284 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011285 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11286 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011287 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11288 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011289 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011290
11291 Supported in default-server: No
11292
11293no-tlsv13
11294 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11295 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11296 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11297 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11298 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011299 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011300
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011301 Supported in default-server: No
11302
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011303no-verifyhost
11304 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11305 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11306 default value.
11307 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11308 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011309
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011310non-stick
11311 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11312 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11313 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11314
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011315observe <mode>
11316 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11317 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11318 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11319 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11320 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11321 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011322 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011323
11324 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011326on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011327 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11328 Currently, four modes are available:
11329 - fastinter: force fastinter
11330 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11331 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11332 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11333 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11334
11335 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11336
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011337on-marked-down <action>
11338 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11339 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011340 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11341 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11342 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11343 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11344 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11345 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11346 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11347 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011348
11349 Actions are disabled by default
11350
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011351on-marked-up <action>
11352 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11353 Currently one action is available:
11354 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11355 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11356 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11357 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11358 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11359 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11360 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11361 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11362
11363 Actions are disabled by default
11364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011365port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011366 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11367 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11368 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11369 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11370 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11371 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11372
11373redir <prefix>
11374 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11375 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11376 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11377 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11378 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11379 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11380 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11381 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011382 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11384 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11385 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11386 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11387 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11388
11389 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011391rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011392 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11393 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11394 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11395
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011396resolve-prefer <family>
11397 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11398 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11399 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11400 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11401
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011402 Default value: ipv6
11403
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011404 Example:
11405
11406 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011407
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011408resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11409 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11410 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011411 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011412 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11413 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11414 configured network, another address is selected.
11415
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011416 Example:
11417
11418 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011419
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011420resolvers <id>
11421 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11422 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011423 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11424 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11425 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11426 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011427
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011428 Example:
11429
11430 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011431
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011432 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011433
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011434send-proxy
11435 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11436 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11437 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11438 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011439 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11440 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11441 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11442 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11443 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11444 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11445 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11446 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11447 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11448 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011449 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11450 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011451
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011452send-proxy-v2
11453 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11454 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11455 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11456 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11457 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011458 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11459 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11460 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011461
11462send-proxy-v2-ssl
11463 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11464 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11465 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11466 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11467 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11468 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11469 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011470 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11471 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011472
11473send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11474 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11475 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11476 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11477 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11478 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11479 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11480 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11481 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011482 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11483 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011485slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011486 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11487 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11488 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11489 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11490 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11491 parameters :
11492
11493 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11494 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11495
11496 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11497 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11498 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11499 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11500
11501 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11502 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11503 seen as failed.
11504
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011505sni <expression>
11506 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11507 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11508 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11509 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011510 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11511 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011512 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11513 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011514
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011515source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011516source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011517source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011518 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11519 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11520 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11521 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11522
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011523 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11524 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11525 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11526 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11527 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11528 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11529 server.
11530
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011531 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11532 specifying the source address without port(s).
11533
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011534ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011535 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11536 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11537 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11538 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11539 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11540 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011541 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11542 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011543
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011544ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11545 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11546 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11547 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11548
11549ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11550 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11551 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11552 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11553
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011554ssl-reuse
11555 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11556 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11557 default value.
11558 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11559 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11560
11561stick
11562 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11563 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11564 default value.
11565 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11566 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011567
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011568tcp-ut <delay>
11569 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11570 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11571 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011572 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011573 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11574 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11575 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11576 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11577 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11578 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11579 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11580 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11581 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011583track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011584 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11585 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11586 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11587 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011588 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11589
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011590tls-tickets
11591 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11592 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11593 default value.
11594 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11595 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011596
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011597verify [none|required]
11598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011599 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011600 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11601 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11602 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11603 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11604 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11605 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11606 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11607 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11608 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11609 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11610 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011611
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011612verifyhost <hostname>
11613 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011614 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11615 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11616 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11617 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11618 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11619 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11620 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11621 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011623weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11625 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11626 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011627 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11628 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11629 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11630 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11631 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11632 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011633
11634
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116355.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11636-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011637
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011638HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11639using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11640configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011641This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11642can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11643workload.
11644This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11645resolution at run time.
11646Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11647carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11648
11649
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116505.3.1. Global overview
11651----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011652
11653As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11654different steps of the process life:
11655
11656 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11657 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11658 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11659
11660 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11661 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11662 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11663
11664A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11665 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11666 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11667 resolution to know this new IP.
11668
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011669When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or s SRV label.
11670HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore a SRV label.
11671If a SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be
11672retrieved from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The
11673SRV label will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed,
11674haproxy will automatically do the same.
11675
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011676A few things important to notice:
11677 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11678 first valid response.
11679
11680 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11681 servers return an error.
11682
11683
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116845.3.2. The resolvers section
11685----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011686
11687This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11688HAProxy.
11689There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11690many name servers.
11691
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011692When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11693uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11694is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11695answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11696
11697When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11698used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11699
11700Two types of behavior can be applied:
11701 1. stop DNS resolution
11702 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11703 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11704 1. ANY query type
11705 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11706 server's parameter
11707 3. remaining family type
11708
11709HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11710 - invalid DNS response packet
11711 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11712 - NX domain
11713 - Query refused by server
11714 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11715
11716HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11717 - no Answer records in the response
11718 - DNS response truncated
11719 - Error in DNS response
11720 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11721 - name server timeout
11722
11723For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11724 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11725 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11726 applied;
11727 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11728 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11729 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11730 stops resolution.
11731
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011732As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11733a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
11734"hold obsolete" seconds without the IP returned.
11735
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011736
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011737resolvers <resolvers id>
11738 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11739
11740A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11741
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011742accepted_payload_size <nb>
11743 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
11744 naeservers configured in this resolvers section.
11745 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11746 by RFC 6891)
11747
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011748 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011749 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11750
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011751 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11752
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011753nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11754 DNS server description:
11755 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11756 <ip> : IP address of the server
11757 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11758
11759hold <status> <period>
11760 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11761 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011762 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011763 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011764 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11765 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11766 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11767
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011768 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011769
11770 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11771 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11772 the healch check.
11773
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011774resolution_pool_size <nb>
11775 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11776 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11777 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11778
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011779resolve_retries <nb>
11780 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11781 giving up.
11782 Default value: 3
11783
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011784 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11785 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11786 type.
11787
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011788timeout <event> <time>
11789 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11790 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11791 events available are:
11792 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11793 been received.
11794 Default value: 1s
11795 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11796 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11797
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011798 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011799
11800 resolvers mydns
11801 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11802 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11803 resolve_retries 3
11804 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011805 hold other 30s
11806 hold refused 30s
11807 hold nx 30s
11808 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011809 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011810 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011811
11812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118136. HTTP header manipulation
11814---------------------------
11815
11816In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11817response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11818request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11819which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011820against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011821
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011822If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11823to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11824but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11825HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11826stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11827because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11828a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11829still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011831This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11832in section 4.2 :
11833
11834 - reqadd <string>
11835 - reqallow <search>
11836 - reqiallow <search>
11837 - reqdel <search>
11838 - reqidel <search>
11839 - reqdeny <search>
11840 - reqideny <search>
11841 - reqpass <search>
11842 - reqipass <search>
11843 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11844 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11845 - reqtarpit <search>
11846 - reqitarpit <search>
11847 - rspadd <string>
11848 - rspdel <search>
11849 - rspidel <search>
11850 - rspdeny <search>
11851 - rspideny <search>
11852 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11853 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11854
11855With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11856is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11857parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11858prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11859Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11860
11861 \t for a tab
11862 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11863 \n for a new line (LF)
11864 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11865 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11866 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11867 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11868 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11869
11870The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11871portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11872above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11873regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
118749 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11875is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11876
11877The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11878after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11879
11880Notes related to these keywords :
11881---------------------------------
11882 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11883 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11884 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11885
11886 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11887 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11888 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11889
11890 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11891 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11892 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11893 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11894 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11895
11896 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11897 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11898 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11899 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11900 useless headers before adding new ones.
11901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011902 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011903 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11904
11905 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11906 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11907 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11908
11909 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11910 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011911 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011912
11913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119147. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11915----------------------------------
11916
11917Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11918client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11919The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11920these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11921but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11922data called patterns.
11923
11924
119257.1. ACL basics
11926---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011927
11928The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11929content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11930from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11931simple :
11932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011933 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011934 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011935 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11936 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11939adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011940
11941In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011943 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011944
11945This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11946Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11947and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011948an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11949conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11950as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11951are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011952
11953ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11954'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11955which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11956
11957There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11958performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011960The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11961specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11962this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011963methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11964ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011965
11966Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11967 - boolean
11968 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11969 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11970 - string
11971 - data block
11972
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011973Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11974converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11975would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11976The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11977which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11978
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011979Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11980keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11981fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11982which are summarized in the table below :
11983
11984 +---------------------+-----------------+
11985 | Sample or converter | Default |
11986 | output type | matching method |
11987 +---------------------+-----------------+
11988 | boolean | bool |
11989 +---------------------+-----------------+
11990 | integer | int |
11991 +---------------------+-----------------+
11992 | ip | ip |
11993 +---------------------+-----------------+
11994 | string | str |
11995 +---------------------+-----------------+
11996 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11997 +---------------------+-----------------+
11998
11999Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12000matching method, see below.
12001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12003 - boolean
12004 - integer or integer range
12005 - IP address / network
12006 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12007 - regular expression
12008 - hex block
12009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012010The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12011
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012012 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12013 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012014 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012015 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012016 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012017 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012018 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12021read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12022if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12023lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12024will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12025beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12026a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12027lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12028exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12029
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012030The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12031parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12032ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12033a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12034check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12035
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012036The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12037socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12038file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012040Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12041loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12042
12043 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12044
12045In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12046the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12047case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12048as well.
12049
12050The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12051sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12052do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12053methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12054is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12055obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12056followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12057default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12058that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12059string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12060
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012061The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12062By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12063string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12064resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12065server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12066waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12067flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12068function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012070There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12071sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12072be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012073
12074 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12075 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012076 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12077 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12078 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12079 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012080
12081 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12082 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012084
12085 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012086 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012087
12088 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012089 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012090
12091 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12092 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12093
12094 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12095 binary or string samples.
12096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012097 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12098 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012100 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12101 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12102 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012104 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12105 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12108 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012110 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12111 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012113 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12114 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012115 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012117 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12118 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12119 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012120
12121For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12122request, it is possible to do :
12123
12124 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12125
12126In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12127buffer, one would use the following acl :
12128
12129 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12130
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012131On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12132possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12133
12134 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012136All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12137criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12138method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12139to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12140criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12141the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012143If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012144the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12145For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012147 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12148 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12149 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12150 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012151
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012152
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012153The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12154types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12155combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12156brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12157default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012159 +-------------------------------------------------+
12160 | Input sample type |
12161 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012162 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012163 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12164 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12165 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012166 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012167 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012168 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012169 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012170 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012172 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012173 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012174 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012175 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012176 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012178 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012179 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012180 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012181 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012182 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012183 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012184 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012185 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012186 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012187 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12188 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12189 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012190
12191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121927.1.1. Matching booleans
12193------------------------
12194
12195In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12196Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12197When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12198that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12199
12200Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12201return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12202"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122057.1.2. Matching integers
12206------------------------
12207
12208Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12209enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12210to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12211
12212Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12213matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12214lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012215
12216For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12217unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12218representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12219
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012220As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12221two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12222instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12223ranges and operators.
12224
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012225For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012226operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12227Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12228of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012230Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012231
12232 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12233 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12234 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12235 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12236 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12237
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012238For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012239
12240 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12241
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012242This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12243
12244 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122477.1.3. Matching strings
12248-----------------------
12249
12250String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12251different forms :
12252
12253 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12254 patterns ;
12255
12256 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12257 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12258
12259 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12260 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12261
12262 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12263 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12264
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012265 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012266 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12267 matches.
12268
12269 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12270 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12271 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012272
12273String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12274exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12275characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12276string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12277to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012278before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012279
12280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12282---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012283
12284Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12285they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12286possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12287passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12288the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012289the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12290match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012291
12292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122937.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12294-------------------------------------
12295
12296It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12297not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12298a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12299to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12300digits may be used upper or lower case.
12301
12302Example :
12303 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12304 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12305
12306
123077.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12308---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012309
12310IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12311netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12312within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012313host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012314difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12315at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12316does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12317parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012318
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012319The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12320abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12321
12322 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12323 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12324 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12325 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12326 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12327 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12328 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12329 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12330
12331Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12332192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12333
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012334IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12335Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12336trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12337IPv6 patterns.
12338
12339HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12340following situations :
12341 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12342 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12343 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12344 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12345 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12346 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12347 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12348 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12349 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12350 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012352
123537.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12354----------------------------------
12355
12356Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12357combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12358
12359 - AND (implicit)
12360 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12361 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012367Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12368indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012370For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12371"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12372requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12373is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12374
12375 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012376 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12377 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12378 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012379
12380To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12381and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12382
12383 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12384 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12385 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12386 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12387
12388 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12389 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12390 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12391 use_backend www if host_www
12392
12393It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12394expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12395be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12396the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12397
12398 The following rule :
12399
12400 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012401 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012402
12403 Can also be written that way :
12404
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012405 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012406
12407It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12408to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12409simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12410sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12411good use is the following :
12412
12413 With named ACLs :
12414
12415 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12416 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12417 monitor fail if site_dead
12418
12419 With anonymous ACLs :
12420
12421 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12422
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012423See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12424keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425
12426
124277.3. Fetching samples
12428---------------------
12429
12430Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12431against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12432sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12433ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12434of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12435available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12436
12437This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12438Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12439compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12440deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12441
12442The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12443matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12444method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12445indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12446
12447As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12448when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12449mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12450the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12451ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12452
12453Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12454multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12455when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12456incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12457are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12458is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12459all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12460
12461Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12462 - name
12463 - name(arg1)
12464 - name(arg1,arg2)
12465
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012466
124677.3.1. Converters
12468-----------------
12469
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012470Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12471of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12472is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12473was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12474has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12475unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12476
12477These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12478sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12479the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12480support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012481
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012482A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12483support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12484supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12485(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12486bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012488The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012489
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001249051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12491 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12492 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12493 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12494 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12495 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12496
12497 Example :
12498 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12499 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12500 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12501 frontend http-in
12502 bind *:8081
12503 default_backend servers
12504 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12505 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12506
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012507add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012508 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012509 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012510 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12511 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012512 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012513 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12514 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12515 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12516 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12517 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012518 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012519
12520and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012521 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012522 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012523 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12524 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012525 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012526 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12527 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12528 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12529 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12530 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012531 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012532
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012533b64dec
12534 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12535 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12536
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012537base64
12538 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12539 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12540 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12541
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012542bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012543 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012544 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12545 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12546 presence of a flag).
12547
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012548bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12549 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12550 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012551 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012552
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012553cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012554 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12555 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012556
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012557crc32([<avalanche>])
12558 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12559 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12560 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12561 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12562 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12563 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12564 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12565 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12566 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12567 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12568 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12569
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012570da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012571 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12572 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12573 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12574 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012575 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012576 configuration language.
12577
12578 Example:
12579 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012580 bind *:8881
12581 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012582 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012583
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012584debug
12585 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12586 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12587 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12588
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012589div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012590 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12591 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012592 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012593 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12594 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012595 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012596 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12597 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12598 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12599 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12600 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012601 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012602
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012603djb2([<avalanche>])
12604 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12605 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12606 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12607 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12608 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12609 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12610 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012611 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12612 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012613
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012614even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012615 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012616 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12617
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012618field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12619 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12620 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12621 list of chars.
12622
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012623hex
12624 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12625 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12626 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12627 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012628
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012629hex2i
12630 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12631 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12632
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012633http_date([<offset>])
12634 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12635 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12636 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12637 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12638 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12639 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012641in_table(<table>)
12642 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12643 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12644 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12645 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12646 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12647
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012648ipmask(<mask>)
12649 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12650 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12651 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12652 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12653
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012654json([<input-code>])
12655 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12656 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012657 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012658 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12659 of errors:
12660 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12661 bytes, ...)
12662 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12663 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12664
12665 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12666 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12667 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12668 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12669 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12670 are :
12671 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12672 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12673 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12674 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12675 error ;
12676 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12677 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12678
12679 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12680 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12681
12682 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012683 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012684 capture request header user-agent len 150
12685 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012686
12687 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12688 GET / HTTP/1.0
12689 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12690
12691 Output log:
12692 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12693
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012694language(<value>[,<default>])
12695 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12696 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12697 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12698 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12699 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12700 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12701 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12702 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12703 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12704 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12705 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12706 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012707
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012708 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012709
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012710 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12711 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012712
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012713 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12714 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12715 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12716 use_backend spanish if es
12717 use_backend french if fr
12718 use_backend english if en
12719 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012720
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012721lower
12722 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12723 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12724 type. The result is of type string.
12725
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012726ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12727 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12728 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12729 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12730 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12731 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12732 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12733
12734 Example :
12735
12736 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12737 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12738 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12739
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012740map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12741map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12742map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12743 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12744 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12745 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12746 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12747 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12748 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12749 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12750 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012751
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012752 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12753 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12754 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012755
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012756 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012757 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012759 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12760 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12761 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12762 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012763 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12764 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012765 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12766 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12767 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12768 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12769 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12770 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12771 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12772 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012773 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12774 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12775 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012776 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12777 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12778 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12779 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12780 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012781
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012782 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12783 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12784 the corresponding match text.
12785
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012786 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12787 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12788 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12789 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12790 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012791
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012792 Example :
12793
12794 # this is a comment and is ignored
12795 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12796 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12797 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12798 | | | `---------- value
12799 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12800 | `---------------------------- key
12801 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12802
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012803mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012804 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12805 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012806 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012807 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12811 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12812 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12813 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012814 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012815
12816mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012817 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012818 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12819 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012820 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012821 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012822 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012823 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12824 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12826 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12827 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012828 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012829
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012830nbsrv
12831 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12832 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12833 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12834 map lookup.
12835
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012836neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012837 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12838 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12839 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12840 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012841
12842not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012843 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012844 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12845 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12846 absence of a flag).
12847
12848odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012849 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012850 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12851
12852or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012853 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012854 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012855 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12856 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012857 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012858 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12859 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12860 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12861 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012863 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012864
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012865regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012866 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12867 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12868 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12869 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12870 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12871 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12872 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12873 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12874 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12875 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012876 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12877 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12878 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12879 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012880
12881 Example :
12882
12883 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12884 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12885 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12886 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12887
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012888capture-req(<id>)
12889 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12890 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12891
12892 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012893 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12894 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012895
12896capture-res(<id>)
12897 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12898 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12899
12900 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012901 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12902 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012903
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012904sdbm([<avalanche>])
12905 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12906 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12907 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12908 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12909 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12910 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12911 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012912 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12913 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012914
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012915set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012916 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12917 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12918 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012919 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012920 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12921 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012922 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012923 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012925 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012926 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012927
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020012928sha1
12929 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
12930 sample with length of 20 bytes.
12931
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012932sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012933 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12934 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012935 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012936 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12937 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012938 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012939 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12940 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012941 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012942 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12943 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012944 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012945 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012946
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012947table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12951 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12952 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12953 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12954
12955
12956table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12957 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12958 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12959 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12960 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12961 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12962 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12963
12964table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12967 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12968 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12969 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12970
12971table_conn_cur(<table>)
12972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12974 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12975 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12976 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12977
12978table_conn_rate(<table>)
12979 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12980 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12981 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12982 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12983 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12984
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012985table_gpt0(<table>)
12986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12989 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12990 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12991
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012992table_gpc0(<table>)
12993 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12994 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12995 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12996 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12997 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12998
12999table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13003 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13004 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13005 sample fetch keyword.
13006
13007table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13008 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13009 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13010 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13011 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13012 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13013
13014table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13015 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13016 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13017 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13018 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13019 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13020 keyword.
13021
13022table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13026 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13027 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13028
13029table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13032 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13033 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13034 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13035 keyword.
13036
13037table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13038 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13039 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13040 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13041 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13042 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13043 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13044 keyword.
13045
13046table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13050 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13051 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13052 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13053 keyword.
13054
13055table_server_id(<table>)
13056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13059 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13060 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13061 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13062
13063table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13067 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13068 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13069 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13070 keyword.
13071
13072table_sess_rate(<table>)
13073 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13074 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13075 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13076 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13077 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13078 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13079 keyword.
13080
13081table_trackers(<table>)
13082 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13083 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13084 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13085 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13086 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13087 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13088 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13089 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13090 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13091 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13092
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013093upper
13094 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13095 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13096 type. The result is of type string.
13097
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013098url_dec
13099 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13100 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13101
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013102unset-var(<var name>)
13103 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13104 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13105 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13106 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13107 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13108 response),
13109 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13110 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13111 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13112 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13113
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013114utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13115 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13116 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13117 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13118 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13119 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13120 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13121
13122 Example :
13123
13124 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13125 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13126 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13127
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013128word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13129 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13130 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13131
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013132wt6([<avalanche>])
13133 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13134 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13135 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13136 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13137 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13138 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13139 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013140 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13141 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013142
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013143xor(<value>)
13144 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013145 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013146 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013147 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013148 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013149 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13150 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013151 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013152 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13153 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013154 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013155 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013156
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013157xxh32([<seed>])
13158 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13159 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13160 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13161 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13162 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13163 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13164 as cryptographically secure.
13165
13166xxh64([<seed>])
13167 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13168 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13169 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13170 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13171 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13172 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13173 as cryptographically secure.
13174
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013175
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131767.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177--------------------------------------------
13178
13179A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13180not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13181"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13182The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13183
13184always_false : boolean
13185 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13186 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13187
13188always_true : boolean
13189 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13190 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13191
13192avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013193 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13195 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13196 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13197 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13198 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13199 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13200 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13201 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13202 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13203 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13204 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13205 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13206 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013209 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13210 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13211 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13212 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13213 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13216 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13217 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13218 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13219 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13220 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13221 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013222
13223 Example :
13224 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13225 backend dynamic
13226 mode http
13227 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13228 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013229
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013230bin(<hexa>) : bin
13231 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13232 of the string.
13233
13234bool(<bool>) : bool
13235 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13236 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013238connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13239 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013240 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13242 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013243
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013244 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013245 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013246 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13247
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013248 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13249 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013250
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013251 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013252 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013254 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13255 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013256 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013257 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013258
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013259 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13260 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013262 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013263
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013264date([<offset>]) : integer
13265 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13266 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13267 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13268 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013269 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13270
13271 Example :
13272
13273 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13274 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013275
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013276distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13277 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13278 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13279 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13280 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13281 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13282 list of supported tokens.
13283
13284distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13285 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13286 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13287 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13288 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13289 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13290 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13291 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13292 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13293 supported tokens.
13294
13295 Example :
13296 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13297 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13298 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13299 # send large files to the big farm
13300 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13301
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013302env(<name>) : string
13303 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13304 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13305 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13306 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13307 certain way.
13308
13309 Examples :
13310 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13311 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13312
13313 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13314 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013316fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13317 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013318 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13319 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013320 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13321 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13322 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13323 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13324 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013325
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013326fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13327 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13328 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13329 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13333 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13334 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13335 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13336 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13337 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13338 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13339 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013340
13341 Example :
13342 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13343 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13344 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13345 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13346 frontend mail
13347 bind :25
13348 mode tcp
13349 maxconn 100
13350 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13351 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13352 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13353 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013354
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013355hostname : string
13356 Returns the system hostname.
13357
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013358int(<integer>) : signed integer
13359 Returns a signed integer.
13360
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013361ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13362 Returns an ipv4.
13363
13364ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13365 Returns an ipv6.
13366
13367meth(<method>) : method
13368 Returns a method.
13369
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013370nbproc : integer
13371 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13372 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13373 and debugging purposes.
13374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13376 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13377 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13378 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013379 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13380 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13381 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013382
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013383proc : integer
13384 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13385 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13386 debugging purposes.
13387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013388queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013389 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13390 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13391 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13393 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13394 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13395 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13396 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13397
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013398rand([<range>]) : integer
13399 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13400 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13401 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13402 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13403 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13406 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13407 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13408 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13409 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13410 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13411 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13412 methods.
13413
13414srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13415 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13416 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13417 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13418 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13419 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13420 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13421 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13422
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013423srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13424 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13425 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13426 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13427 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13428 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13429 fetch methods.
13430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13432 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13433 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013434 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13436 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13437 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13438 overloading servers).
13439
13440 Example :
13441 # Redirect to a separate back
13442 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13443 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13444 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13445
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013446stopping : boolean
13447 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13448 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13449 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13450
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013451str(<string>) : string
13452 Returns a string.
13453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13455 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13456 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13457
13458table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13459 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13460 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13461 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13462
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013463var(<var-name>) : undefined
13464 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013465 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13466 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013467 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013468 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13469 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013470 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013471 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13472 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013473 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013474 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013475
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013477----------------------------------
13478
13479The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13480closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13481methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13482sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13483TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013484the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13485counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13486"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013487argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13488the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13489this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013490
13491be_id : integer
13492 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13493 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13494
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013495be_name : string
13496 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13497 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499dst : ip
13500 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13501 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13502 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13503 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13504 RFC 4291.
13505
13506dst_conn : integer
13507 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13508 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13509 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13510 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13511 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13512 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13513 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13514 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013515
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013516dst_is_local : boolean
13517 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13518 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13519 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13520 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13521 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13522 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13523 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13524 it only once per connection.
13525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013526dst_port : integer
13527 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13528 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13529 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13530 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13531 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13532 an HTTP header.
13533
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013534fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13535 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13536 header.
13537
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013538fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13539 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13540 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13541 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13542 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13543 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13544 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13545
13546fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13547 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13548 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13549 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13550 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13551 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13552 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13553
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013554fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13555 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13556 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13557 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13558 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13559
13560fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13561 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13562 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13563 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13564 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13565
13566fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13567 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13568 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13569 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13570 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13571
13572fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13573 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13574 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13575 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13576 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13577
13578fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13579 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13580 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13581 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13582 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13583
13584fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13585 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13586 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13587 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13588 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013590fe_id : integer
13591 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013592 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013593 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13594
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013595fe_name : string
13596 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13597 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13598 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13599
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013600sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013601sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13602sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13603sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013604 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13605 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13606 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13607
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013608sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013609sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13610sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13611sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013612 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13613 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13614 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013616sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013617sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13618sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13619sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013620 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13621 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013622 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13623 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13624 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013625
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013626 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013627 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13628 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013629 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13630 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13631 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013632 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13633 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13634
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013635sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013636sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13637sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13638sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013639 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13640 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13641
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013642sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013643sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13644sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13645sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013646 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13647 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13648 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13649
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013650sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013651sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13652sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13653sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013654 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13655 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13656 See also src_conn_rate.
13657
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013658sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013659sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13660sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13661sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013662 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013663 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013664
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013665sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13666sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13667sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13668sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13669 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13670 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013672sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013673sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13674sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13675sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013676 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13677 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13678 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013679 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13680 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13681 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013682
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013683sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013684sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13685sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13686sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013687 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13688 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13689 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013691sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013692sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13693sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13694sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013695 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13696 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13697 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13698 src_http_err_rate.
13699
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013700sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013701sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13702sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13703sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013704 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13705 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13706 src_http_req_cnt.
13707
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013708sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013709sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13710sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13711sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013712 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13713 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13714 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13715 src_http_req_rate.
13716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013717sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013718sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13719sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13720sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013721 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013722 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13723 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13724 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13725 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013726
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013727 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013728 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13729 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013730 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13731
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013732sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013733sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13734sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13735sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013736 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13737 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13738 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013739
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013740sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013741sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13742sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13743sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013744 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13745 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13746 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013748sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013749sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13750sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13751sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013752 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13753 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13754 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13755 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013756 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013757 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013759sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013760sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13761sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13762sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013763 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13764 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13765 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13766 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13767 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013768 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013770sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013771sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13772sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13773sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013774 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13775 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13776 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13777
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013778sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013779sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13780sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13781sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013782 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13783 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013784 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013785 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13786 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013787 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13788 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13789 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791so_id : integer
13792 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13793 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13794 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013796src : ip
13797 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13798 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13799 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13800 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013801 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13802 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13803 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13804 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013805
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013806 Example:
13807 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13808 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013810src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13811 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13812 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13813 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013814 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13817 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13818 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013819 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013820 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013822src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13823 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13824 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13825 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13826 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13827 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13828 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013829
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013830 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013831 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13832 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13833 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13834 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013835 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013836 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13837 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013839src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013840 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013841 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013842 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013843 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013845src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013846 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013847 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13848 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013849 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13852 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13853 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13854 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013855 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013857src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013858 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013859 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013860 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013861 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013862
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013863src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13864 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13865 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13866 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13867 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013869src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013870 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013871 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013872 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13873 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013874 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13875 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13876 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013878src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13879 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13880 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013881 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013882 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013883 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013885src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13886 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13887 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13888 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13889 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013890 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013892src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13893 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13894 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13895 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013896 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013898src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13899 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13900 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13901 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013902 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013903 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013905src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13906 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13907 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13908 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013909 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013910 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13911 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013912
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013913 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013914 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013915 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013916 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013917
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013918src_is_local : boolean
13919 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13920 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13921 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13922 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13923 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13924 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13925 once per connection.
13926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013927src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013928 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13929 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13930 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13931 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13932 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013934src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013935 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13936 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13937 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13938 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13939 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013941src_port : integer
13942 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13943 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13944 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13945 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13948 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013949 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13950 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13951 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013952 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13955 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13956 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13957 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13958 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013959 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13962 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13963 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13964 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13965 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13966 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13967 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13968 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13969 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013970
13971 Example :
13972 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13973 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13974 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13975 listen ssh
13976 bind :22
13977 mode tcp
13978 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013979 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013980 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013981 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013983srv_id : integer
13984 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13985 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13986 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013987
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013991The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13992closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13993when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13994usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013995future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013996
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001399751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13998 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13999 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14000 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14001 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14002 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14003
14004 Example :
14005 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14006 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14007 # the request.
14008 frontend http-in
14009 bind *:8081
14010 default_backend servers
14011 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14012 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14013
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014014ssl_bc : boolean
14015 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14016 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14017 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14018
14019ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14020 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14021 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14022
14023ssl_bc_cipher : string
14024 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14025 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14026
14027ssl_bc_protocol : string
14028 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14029 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14030
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014031ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014032 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014033 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14034 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014035
14036ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14037 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14038 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14039 if session was reused or not.
14040
14041ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14042 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14043 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14046 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14047 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14048 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14049 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14050 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014052ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14053 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14054 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14055 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14056 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014057
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014058ssl_c_der : binary
14059 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14060 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14061 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063ssl_c_err : integer
14064 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14065 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14066 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14067 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14068 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14071 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14072 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14073 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14074 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14075 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14076 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14077 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14078 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014080ssl_c_key_alg : string
14081 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14082 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14083 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014085ssl_c_notafter : string
14086 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14087 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14088 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014090ssl_c_notbefore : string
14091 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14092 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14093 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14096 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14097 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14098 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14099 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14100 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14101 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14102 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14103 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105ssl_c_serial : binary
14106 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14107 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14108 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14111 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14112 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14113 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014114 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14115 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14116
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014117 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014118 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14121 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14122 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14123 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125ssl_c_used : boolean
14126 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14127 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014129ssl_c_verify : integer
14130 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14131 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14132 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14133 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135ssl_c_version : integer
14136 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14137 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014138
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014139ssl_f_der : binary
14140 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14141 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14142 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14145 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14146 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14147 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14148 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014149 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14151 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14152 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014154ssl_f_key_alg : string
14155 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14156 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14157 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159ssl_f_notafter : string
14160 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14161 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14162 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014164ssl_f_notbefore : string
14165 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14166 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14167 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014169ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14170 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14171 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14172 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14173 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14174 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14175 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14176 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14177 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179ssl_f_serial : binary
14180 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14181 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14182 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014183
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014184ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14185 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14186 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14187 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14190 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14191 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14192 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194ssl_f_version : integer
14195 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14196 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14197
14198ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014199 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14200 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14201 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014203 Example :
14204 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14205 listen http-https
14206 bind :80
14207 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14208 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14209
14210ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14211 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14212 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14213
14214ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014215 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014216 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14217 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14218 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14219 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14220 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14221 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14222 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14223 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225ssl_fc_cipher : string
14226 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14227 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014228
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014229ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14230 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14231 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014232 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014233
14234ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14235 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14236 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014237 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014238
14239ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14240 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14241 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14242 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014243 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14244 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014245
14246ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14247 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14248 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014249 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014251ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014252 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14253 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014254 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14255 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14256 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14257 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014258
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014259ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14260 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14261 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14262 wait until the handshake happened.
14263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14265 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014266 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14267 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14268 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14269 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014270
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014271ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014272 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14273 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014275ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014276 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014277 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14278 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14279 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14280 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14281 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14282 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14283 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014285ssl_fc_protocol : string
14286 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14287 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014288
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014289ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014290 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014291 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14292 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014294ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14295 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14296 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14297 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14298 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014300ssl_fc_sni : string
14301 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14302 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14303 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14304 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14305 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14306
14307 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14308 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14309 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014310 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14311 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014313 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014314 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14315 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014317ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14318 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14319 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014320
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014321
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143227.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014323------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14326sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14327only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14328For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14329be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14330can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14331sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14332for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14333content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014335payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14336 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14337 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14338 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014340payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14341 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14342 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14343 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014344
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014345req.hdrs : string
14346 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14347 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14348 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14349 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14350
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014351req.hdrs_bin : binary
14352 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14353 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14354 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14355 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14356 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14357 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14358
14359 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14360
14361 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14362 str: <int:length><bytes>
14363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014364req.len : integer
14365req_len : integer (deprecated)
14366 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14367 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14368 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14369 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14370 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14371 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14372 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14373 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014375req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14376 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014377 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14378 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14379 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14380 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014382 ACL alternatives :
14383 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14386 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14387 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14388 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14389 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391 ACL alternatives :
14392 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396req.proto_http : boolean
14397req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14398 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14399 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14400 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14401 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14402 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14403 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14404 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406 Example:
14407 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14408 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14409 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014410 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14413rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14414 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14415 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14416 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14417 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14418 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14419 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14420 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014422 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14423 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14424 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14425 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14426 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14427 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429 ACL derivatives :
14430 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432 Example :
14433 listen tse-farm
14434 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14435 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14436 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14437 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14438 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14439 persist rdp-cookie
14440 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14441 # This is only useful makes sense if
14442 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14443 stick-table type string size 204800
14444 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14445 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14446 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014448 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14449 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014451req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14452rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14453 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14454 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14455 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14456 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458 ACL derivatives :
14459 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014460
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014461req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14462 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14463 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014464 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14465 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14466 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14467 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14468 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14471req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14472 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14473 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14474 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14475 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14476 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14477 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14478 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480req.ssl_sni : string
14481req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14482 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14483 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14484 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14485 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14486 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14487 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14488 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14489 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14490 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14491 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14492 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14493 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495 ACL derivatives :
14496 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498 Examples :
14499 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14500 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14501 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14502 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14503 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014504
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014505req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14506 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14507 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14508 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14509 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14510 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14511 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14512 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14513 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14514 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516req.ssl_ver : integer
14517req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14518 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14519 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14520 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14521 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14522 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14523 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14524 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14525 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14526 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528 ACL derivatives :
14529 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014530
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014531res.len : integer
14532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14533 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14534 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14535 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14536 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14537 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14538 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14539 content inspection.
14540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014541res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14542 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014543 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14544 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14545 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14546 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014548res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14549 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14550 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14551 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14552 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014555
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014556res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14557rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14558 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14559 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14560 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14561 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14562 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14563 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14564 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014566wait_end : boolean
14567 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14568 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14569 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14570 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14571 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14572 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14573 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14574 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014576 Examples :
14577 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14578 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14579 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014581 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14582 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14583 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14584 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14585 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14586 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14587 tcp-request content reject
14588
14589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591--------------------------------------
14592
14593It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14594This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14595data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14596its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14597HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14598content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14599to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14600more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14601response are indexed.
14602
14603base : string
14604 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14605 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14606 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14607 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14608 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14609 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14610 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14611 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14612
14613 ACL derivatives :
14614 base : exact string match
14615 base_beg : prefix match
14616 base_dir : subdir match
14617 base_dom : domain match
14618 base_end : suffix match
14619 base_len : length match
14620 base_reg : regex match
14621 base_sub : substring match
14622
14623base32 : integer
14624 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14625 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14626 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014627 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14628 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14629 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630
14631base32+src : binary
14632 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14633 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14634 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14635 per-URL counters.
14636
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014637capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14638 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14639 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14640 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14641
14642capture.req.method : string
14643 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14644 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14645 because it's allocated.
14646
14647capture.req.uri : string
14648 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14649 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14650 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14651 allocated.
14652
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014653capture.req.ver : string
14654 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14655 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14656 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14657
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014658capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14659 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14660 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14661 The first entry is an index of 0.
14662 See also: "capture response header"
14663
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014664capture.res.ver : string
14665 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14666 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14667 persistent flag.
14668
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014669req.body : binary
14670 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14671 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14672 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14673 the first chunk is analyzed.
14674
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014675req.body_param([<name>) : string
14676 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14677 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14678 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14679 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14680 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14681 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14682 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14683 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14684 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14685 given.
14686
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014687req.body_len : integer
14688 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14689 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14690 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14691 "option http-buffer-request".
14692
14693req.body_size : integer
14694 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14695 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14696 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14697 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14698 "option http-buffer-request".
14699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014700req.cook([<name>]) : string
14701cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14702 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14703 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14704 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14705 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14706 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14707 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14708 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14709 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14710
14711 ACL derivatives :
14712 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14713 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14714 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14715 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14716 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14717 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14718 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14719 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14722cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14723 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14724 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014726req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14727cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14728 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14729 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14730 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14731 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014733cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14734 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14735 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14736 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14737 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014738 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014739 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14740 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14741 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14742 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014744hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14745 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14746 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14747 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14748 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014749 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14752 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14753 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14754 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14755 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14756 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14757 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14758 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14759 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014761req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14762 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14763 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14764 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14765 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14768 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14769 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14770 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14771 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14772 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14773 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14774 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14775 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014776 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14778 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780 ACL derivatives :
14781 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14782 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14783 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14784 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14785 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14786 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14787 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14788 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14789
14790req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14791hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14792 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14793 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14794 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14795 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14796 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14797 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14798 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14799 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14800 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14801
14802req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14803hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14804 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14805 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14806 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14807 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14808 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14809 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14810 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14811 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14812
14813req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14814hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14815 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14816 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14817 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14818 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14819 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14820 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14821 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14822
14823http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14824 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14825 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14826 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14827 basic auth is supported.
14828
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014829http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14830 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14831 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14832 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14833 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14835 basic auth is supported.
14836
14837 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014838 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14839 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14840 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14841 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842
14843http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014844 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14845 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014846 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14847 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849method : integer + string
14850 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14851 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14852 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14853 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14854 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14855 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14856 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858 ACL derivatives :
14859 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861 Example :
14862 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14863 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14864 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866path : string
14867 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14868 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14869 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14870 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14871 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14872 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14873 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014875 ACL derivatives :
14876 path : exact string match
14877 path_beg : prefix match
14878 path_dir : subdir match
14879 path_dom : domain match
14880 path_end : suffix match
14881 path_len : length match
14882 path_reg : regex match
14883 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014884
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014885query : string
14886 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14887 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14888 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14889 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014890 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014891 which stops before the question mark.
14892
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014893req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14894 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14895 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14896 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14897 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899req.ver : string
14900req_ver : string (deprecated)
14901 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14902 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14903 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905 ACL derivatives :
14906 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908res.comp : boolean
14909 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14910 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14911 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913res.comp_algo : string
14914 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14915 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14916 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918res.cook([<name>]) : string
14919scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14920 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14921 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14922 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924 ACL derivatives :
14925 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14928scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14929 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14930 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14931 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014933res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14934scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14935 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14936 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14937 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14940 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14941 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14942 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14943 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14944 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14945 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14946 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14947 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14948 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14951 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14952 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14953 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14954 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14955 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14958shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14959 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14960 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14961 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14962 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14963 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14964 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14965 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14966 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 ACL derivatives :
14969 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14970 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14971 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14972 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14973 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14974 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14975 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14976 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14977
14978res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14979shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14980 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14981 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14982 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14983 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14984 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014986res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14987shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14988 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14989 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14990 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14991 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14992 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14993 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014994
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014995res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14996 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14997 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14998 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14999 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15002shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15003 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15004 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15005 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15006 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15007 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15008 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015010res.ver : string
15011resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15012 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15013 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015 ACL derivatives :
15016 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015018set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15019 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15020 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015021 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015024 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15025 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027status : integer
15028 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15029 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15030 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015031
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015032unique-id : string
15033 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15034 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15035 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15036 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15037 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15038 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040url : string
15041 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15042 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15043 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15044 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15045 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15046 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15047 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015049 ACL derivatives :
15050 url : exact string match
15051 url_beg : prefix match
15052 url_dir : subdir match
15053 url_dom : domain match
15054 url_end : suffix match
15055 url_len : length match
15056 url_reg : regex match
15057 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059url_ip : ip
15060 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15061 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15062 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15063 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15064 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15065 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15066 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068url_port : integer
15069 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15070 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15071 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15072 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015073
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015074urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15075url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15077 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015078 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15079 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15080 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15081 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15083 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015084 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15085 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087 ACL derivatives :
15088 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15089 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15090 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15091 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15092 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15093 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15094 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15095 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015096
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098 Example :
15099 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15100 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15101 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15102 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015103
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015104urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15106 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15107 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015108
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015109url32 : integer
15110 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15111 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15112 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15113 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15114 is an unsigned integer.
15115
15116url32+src : binary
15117 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15118 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15119 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15120
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151227.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015123---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015125Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15126every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015127order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015129ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15130---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015131FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015132HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015133HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15134HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015135HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15136HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15137HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15138HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15139LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015140METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015141METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015142METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15143METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15144METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15145METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015146METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015147METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015148RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015149REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015150TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015151WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15152---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015153
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151558. Logging
15156----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015157
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015158One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15159provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15160very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15161provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15162state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015163to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015164headers.
15165
15166In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15167about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15168send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15169
15170 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15171 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15172 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15173 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15174 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015175 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15176 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015177
15178The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15179allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15180as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15181while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15182real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15183delay.
15184
15185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151868.1. Log levels
15187---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015188
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015189TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015190source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015191HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15192in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15193track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15194syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15195about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015196
15197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151988.2. Log formats
15199----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015200
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015201HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015202and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15203slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15204options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015205
15206 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15207 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15208 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15209 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15210 extents.
15211
15212 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15213 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15214 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15215 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15216 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15217
15218 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15219 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15220 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15221 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15222 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15223
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015224 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15225 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15226 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15227 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15228
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015229 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15230
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015231Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15232specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15233field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15234servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15235always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15236identifier.
15237
15238Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15239 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15240 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15241 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15242 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15243
15244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152458.2.1. Default log format
15246-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015247
15248This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15249as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15250format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15251
15252 Example :
15253 listen www
15254 mode http
15255 log global
15256 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15257
15258 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15259 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15260 (www/HTTP)
15261
15262 Field Format Extract from the example above
15263 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15264 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15265 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15266 4 'to' to
15267 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15268 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15269
15270Detailed fields description :
15271 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15272 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15273 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15274 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15275 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15276 and processed the connection.
15277 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15278
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015279In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15280"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15281connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15282
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015283It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15284will eventually disappear.
15285
15286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152878.2.2. TCP log format
15288---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015289
15290The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15291is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15292information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15293counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15294emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15295environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15296the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15297sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015298specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15299not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15300fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15301marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015302
15303 Example :
15304 frontend fnt
15305 mode tcp
15306 option tcplog
15307 log global
15308 default_backend bck
15309
15310 backend bck
15311 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15312
15313 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15314 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15315 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15316
15317 Field Format Extract from the example above
15318 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15319 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15320 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15321 4 frontend_name fnt
15322 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15323 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15324 7 bytes_read* 212
15325 8 termination_state --
15326 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15327 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15328
15329Detailed fields description :
15330 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015331 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15332 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15333 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015334 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15335 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15336 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015337
15338 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015339 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15340 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15341 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015342
15343 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15344 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15345 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15346 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15347
15348 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15349 and processed the connection.
15350
15351 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15352 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15353 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15354 applications.
15355
15356 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15357 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15358 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15359 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15360 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15361
15362 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15363 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15364 See "Timers" below for more details.
15365
15366 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15367 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15368 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15369 "Timers" below for more details.
15370
15371 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015372 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015373 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15374 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15375 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15376 details.
15377
15378 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15379 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15380 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15381 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15382 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15383
15384 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15385 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15386 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15387 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15388 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15389 for more details.
15390
15391 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015392 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015393 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15394 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15395 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015396 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015397
15398 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15399 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15400 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15401 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15402 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15403 caused by a denial of service attack.
15404
15405 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15406 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15407 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15408 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15409 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15410 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15411 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15412 denial of service attack.
15413
15414 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15415 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15416 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15417 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15418 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15419 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15420 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15421 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15422 be processed than on other servers.
15423
15424 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15425 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15426 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15427 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15428 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15429 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15430 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15431 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15432 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15433 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15434 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15435 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15436 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15437
15438 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15439 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15440 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15441 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15442 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15443 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15444 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15445 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15446
15447 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15448 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15449 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15450 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15451 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15452 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15453 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15454 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15455 occurs.
15456
15457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154588.2.3. HTTP log format
15459----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015460
15461The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15462is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15463the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15464are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15465emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15466generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15467"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15468which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015469frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15470is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015471
15472Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15473slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15474with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15475
15476 Example :
15477 frontend http-in
15478 mode http
15479 option httplog
15480 log global
15481 default_backend bck
15482
15483 backend static
15484 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15485
15486 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15487 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15488 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015489 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015490
15491 Field Format Extract from the example above
15492 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15493 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015494 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015495 4 frontend_name http-in
15496 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015497 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015498 7 status_code 200
15499 8 bytes_read* 2750
15500 9 captured_request_cookie -
15501 10 captured_response_cookie -
15502 11 termination_state ----
15503 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15504 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15505 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15506 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15507 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015508
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015509Detailed fields description :
15510 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015511 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15512 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15513 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015514 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15515 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15516 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015517
15518 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015519 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15520 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15521 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015522
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015523 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15524 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015525
15526 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15527 and processed the connection.
15528
15529 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15530 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15531 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15532
15533 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15534 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15535 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15536 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15537 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15538 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15539
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015540 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15541 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15542 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15543 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15544 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15545 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15546 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015547
15548 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15549 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15550 See "Timers" below for more details.
15551
15552 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15553 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15554 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15555 below for more details.
15556
15557 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15558 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15559 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15560 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15561 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15562 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15563 for more details.
15564
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015565 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15566 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15567 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15568 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15569 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15570 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15571 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15572 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015573
15574 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15575 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15576 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15577
15578 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15579 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15580 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15581 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15582 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15583 overflowing.
15584
15585 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15586 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15587 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15588 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15589 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15590 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15591 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15592 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15593
15594 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15595 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15596 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15597 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15598 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15599 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15600 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15601 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15602
15603 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15604 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15605 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15606 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15607 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15608 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15609 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15610
15611 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015612 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015613 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15614 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15615 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015616 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015617 system.
15618
15619 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15620 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15621 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15622 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15623 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15624 caused by a denial of service attack.
15625
15626 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15627 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15628 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15629 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15630 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15631 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15632 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15633 denial of service attack.
15634
15635 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15636 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15637 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15638 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15639 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15640 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15641 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15642 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15643 processed than on other servers.
15644
15645 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15646 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15647 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15648 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15649 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15650 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15651 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15652 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15653 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15654 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15655 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15656 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15657 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15658
15659 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15660 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15661 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15662 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15663 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15664 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15665 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15666 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15667
15668 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15669 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15670 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15671 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15672 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15673 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15674 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15675 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15676 occurs.
15677
15678 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15679 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15680 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15681 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15682 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15683 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15684 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15685 cookies" below for more details.
15686
15687 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15688 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15689 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15690 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15691 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15692 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15693 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15694 and cookies" below for more details.
15695
15696 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15697 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15698 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15699 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15700 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15701 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15702 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15703 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15704
15705
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200157068.2.4. Custom log format
15707------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015708
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015709The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015710mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015711
15712HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15713Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15714separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15715prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15716
15717Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15718variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015719("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015720
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015721If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015722as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015723less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15724the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15725
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015726Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015727In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015728in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015729
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015730Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15731'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15732https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15733such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15734
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015735Flags are :
15736 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015737 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015738 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15739 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015740
15741 Example:
15742
15743 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15744 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15745
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015746 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15747
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015748At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15749
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015750 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15751 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015752
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015753the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015754
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015755 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15756 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15757 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015758
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015759and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15760
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015761 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15762 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015763
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015764Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15765
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015766 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015767 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015768 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15769 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15770 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015771 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15772 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15773 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015774 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015775 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15776 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015777 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015778 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15779 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015780 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015781 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015782 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015783 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015784 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015785 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015786 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015787 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15788 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15789 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15790 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15791 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015792 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015793 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15794 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015795 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015796 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15797 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015798 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15799 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15800 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015801 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015802 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15803 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015804 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015805 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15806 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15807 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015808 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015809 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015810 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15811 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15812 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15813 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015814 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015815 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015816 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015817 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015818 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015819 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015820 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15821 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15822 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015823 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015824 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15825 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015826 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015827 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15828 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15829 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015830 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015831 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015832 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015833
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015834 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015835
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015836
158378.2.5. Error log format
15838-----------------------
15839
15840When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15841protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15842By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15843"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15844will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15845logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15846
15847The format looks like this :
15848
15849 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15850 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15851 Connection error during SSL handshake
15852
15853 Field Format Extract from the example above
15854 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15855 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15856 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15857 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15858 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15859
15860These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15861failures.
15862
15863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158648.3. Advanced logging options
15865-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015866
15867Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15868just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15869options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15870for more information about their usage.
15871
15872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158738.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15874------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015875
15876It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15877haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15878commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15879monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15880ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15881
15882 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15883 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15884 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15885 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15886
15887 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15888 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15889 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015890 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015891 such as other load-balancers.
15892
15893 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15894 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15895 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15896
15897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158988.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15899----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015900
15901The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15902what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15903or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15904"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15905just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15906log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15907after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15908is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15909with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15910with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15911
15912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159138.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15914------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015915
15916Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15917for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15918"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15919retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15920raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15921a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15922file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15923you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15924"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15925
15926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159278.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15928--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015929
15930Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15931multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15932them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15933"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15934logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15935error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15936and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15937too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15938useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15939alternative.
15940
15941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159428.4. Timing events
15943------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015944
15945Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15946reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15947the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15948frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015949mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15950addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15951
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015952Timings events in HTTP mode:
15953
15954 first request 2nd request
15955 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15956 t tr t tr ...
15957 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15958 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15959 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15960 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15961 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15962
15963Timings events in TCP mode:
15964
15965 TCP session
15966 |<----------------->|
15967 t t
15968 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15969 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15970 |<------ Tt ------->|
15971
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015972 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15973 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15974 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15975 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15976 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15977 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15978 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015979
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015980 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15981 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15982 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15983 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15984 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15985 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15986 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15987 nothing was received on the connection.
15988
15989 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15990 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15991 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15992 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15993 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15994 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15995 request typed by hand during a test.
15996
15997 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15998 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15999 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16000 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16001 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16002 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16003 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016004
16005 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16006 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16007 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16008 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16009 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16010
16011 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16012 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16013 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16014 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16015 connection never established.
16016
16017 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16018 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16019 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16020 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16021 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16022 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16023 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16024 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16025 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16026 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16027 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16028
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016029 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16030 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16031 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16032 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16033 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16034 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16035
16036 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16037
16038 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16039 "Ta" can never be negative.
16040
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016041 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16042 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016043 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16044 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016045 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016046
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016047 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016048
16049 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016050 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16051 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016052
16053These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16054protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16055that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016056due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16057"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16058that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016059
16060Most common cases :
16061
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016062 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16063 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16064 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16065 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16066 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16067 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16068 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16069 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16070 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16071 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16072 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016073 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016074
16075 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16076 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16077 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16078 of ms on remote networks.
16079
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016080 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16081 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16082 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016083
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016084 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16085 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16086 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16087 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16088 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16089 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16090 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16091 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16092 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016093
16094Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16095
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016096 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016098 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016099
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016100 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016101 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16102 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016104 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016105 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16106 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16107 flags.
16108
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016109 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16110 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016111 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16112 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16113 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16114 the client connection was maintained open.
16115
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016116 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016117 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016118 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016119 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16120
16121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161228.5. Session state at disconnection
16123-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016124
16125TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16126"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
161272-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16128each of which has a special meaning :
16129
16130 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16131 session to terminate :
16132
16133 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16134
16135 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16136 server explicitly refused it.
16137
16138 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16139 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16140 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16141 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016142 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16143
16144 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16145 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016146
16147 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16148 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16149 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16150 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16151 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16152
16153 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16154 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16155 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16156 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16157 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16158
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016159 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16160 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16161
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016162 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16163 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16164 backup connections when going up.
16165
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016166 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16167
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16169 send or receive data.
16170
16171 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16172 send or receive data.
16173
16174 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16175 with nothing left in the buffers.
16176
16177 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16178
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016179 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016180 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16181
16182 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16183 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16184 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16185 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16186 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16187
16188 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16189 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16190
16191 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16192 server (HTTP only).
16193
16194 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16195
16196 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16197 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16198 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16199
16200 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16201 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16202 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16203
16204 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16205
16206 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16207 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16208
16209 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16210 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16211 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16212
16213 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16214 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016215 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16216 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016217
16218 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16219 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16220 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16221 another server.
16222
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016223 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016224 server.
16225
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016226 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16227 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16228 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16229 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16230
16231 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16232 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16233 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16234 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16235
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016236 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16237 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16238 "use-server" rule).
16239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016240 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16241
16242 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16243 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16244
16245 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16246
16247 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16248 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16249 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16250
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016251 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16252 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016253 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016254 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16255 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16256
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016257 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16258
16259 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16260 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16261
16262 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16263
16264 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16265
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016266The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16267was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016268helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16269starvation, attacks, etc...
16270
16271The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16272alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16273easier finding and understanding.
16274
16275 Flags Reason
16276
16277 -- Normal termination.
16278
16279 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16280 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16281 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16282 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16283
16284 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16285 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16286 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16287 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16288 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16289 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016290
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016291 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16292 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016293 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016294
16295 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16296 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16297 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16298
16299 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16300 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16301 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16302 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16303 the server takes too long to respond.
16304
16305 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16306 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16307 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16308 long a time to respond.
16309
16310 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16311 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16312 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16313 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016314 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16315 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016316
16317 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16318 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16319 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16320 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16321 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016322 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016323 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16324 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16325 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16326 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16327 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16328 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16329 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16330 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16331 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16332 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16333 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16334 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016335
16336 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16337 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016338 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16339 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16340 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16341 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016342
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016343 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16344 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016346 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016347 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16348 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16349 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16350 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16351 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16352
16353 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16354 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16355 503 or 504 here.
16356
16357 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16358 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16359 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16360 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16361 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16362
16363 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16364 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016365 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016366 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16367 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16368
16369 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16370 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16371 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16372 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16373 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16374 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16375 between haproxy and the server.
16376
16377 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16378 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16379 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16380 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16381 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16382 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16383 solution is to fix the application.
16384
16385 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16386 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16387 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16388 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16389 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16390 external attacks.
16391
16392 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16393 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016394 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016395 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16396 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16397
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016398 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16399 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16400 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016401 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16402 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016403
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016404 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16405 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16406 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16407 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016408 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16409 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16410 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16411 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16412 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016413
16414 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16415 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16416 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16417 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16418
16419 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16420 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16421 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16422 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16423
16424 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16425 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16426 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16427 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16428
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016429The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16430persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16431important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16432re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16433
16434 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16435
16436 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16437 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16438 set on a GET request.
16439
16440 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16441 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016442 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016443 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16444
16445 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16446 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16447 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16448
16449 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16450 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16451 already got a cookie.
16452
16453 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16454 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16455 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16456 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16457 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16458
16459 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16460 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16461 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16462
16463 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16464 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16465 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16466
16467 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16468 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16469
16470 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16471 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16472 then advertised in the response.
16473
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164758.6. Non-printable characters
16476-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016477
16478In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16479consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16480converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16481prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16482being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16483escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16484is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16485'}' when logging headers.
16486
16487Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16488issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16489containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16490
16491Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16492the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16493performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16494
16495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16497---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016498
16499Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16500achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016501section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016502cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16503the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16504the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016505locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016506not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16507user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16508a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16509wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16510
16511 Examples :
16512 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16513 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16514
16515 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16516 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16517
16518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165198.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16520---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016521
16522Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16523proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16524the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16525server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16526
16527Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16528response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016529section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016530
16531It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016532time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16533appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016534are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16535and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16536follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16537request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16538in the logs.
16539
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016540As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16541frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16542an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016544 Example :
16545 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16546 listen proxy-out
16547 mode http
16548 option httplog
16549 option logasap
16550 log global
16551 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16552
16553 # log the name of the virtual server
16554 capture request header Host len 20
16555
16556 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16557 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16558
16559 # log the beginning of the referrer
16560 capture request header Referer len 20
16561
16562 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16563 capture response header Server len 20
16564
16565 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16566 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16567
16568 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16569 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16570
16571 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16572 capture response header Via len 20
16573
16574 # log the URL location during a redirection
16575 capture response header Location len 20
16576
16577 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16578 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16579 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16580 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16581 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16582
16583 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16584 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16585 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16586 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016587 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016588
16589 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16590 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16591 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16592 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16593 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016594 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016595
16596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165978.9. Examples of logs
16598---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016599
16600These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16601them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16602reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16603
16604 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16605 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16606 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16607
16608 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16609 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16610
16611 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16612 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16613 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16614
16615 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16616 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16617
16618 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16619 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16620 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16621
16622 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016623 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16625 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16626
16627 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16628 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16629 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16630
16631 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16632 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016633 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016634 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16635 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16636 to return the 502 and not the server.
16637
16638 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016639 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016640
16641 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16642 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16643 Nothing was sent to any server.
16644
16645 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16646 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16647
16648 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16649 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16650 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16651 send a 408 return code to the client.
16652
16653 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16654 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16655
16656 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16657 5 seconds ("c----").
16658
16659 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16660 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016661 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016662
16663 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016664 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016665 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16666 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16667 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16668 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16669 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016670
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016671
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200166729. Supported filters
16673--------------------
16674
16675Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16676accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16677unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16678
16679See also : "filter"
16680
166819.1. Trace
16682----------
16683
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016684filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016685
16686 Arguments:
16687 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16688 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16689
16690 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16691 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16692 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16693 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16694
16695 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16696 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16697 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16698 amount of the parsed data.
16699
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016700 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16701
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016702This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16703callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16704information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16705filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16706
16707Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16708tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16709a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16710
16711
167129.2. HTTP compression
16713---------------------
16714
16715filter compression
16716
16717The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16718keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16719when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16720use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16721used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16722filters evaluation order.
16723
16724See also : "compression"
16725
16726
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200167279.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16728--------------------------------------------
16729
16730filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16731
16732 Arguments :
16733
16734 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16735 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16736 parsed.
16737
16738 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16739 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16740 part must be placed in its own scope.
16741
16742The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16743external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16744streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16745exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16746also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16747
16748SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16749the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16750
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016751For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016752"doc/SPOE.txt".
16753
16754Important note:
16755 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16756 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016758/*
16759 * Local variables:
16760 * fill-column: 79
16761 * End:
16762 */